1
 
   
      AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON MAY 22, 1998
    
                                                      REGISTRATION NO. 333-49645
================================================================================
 
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                            ------------------------
 
   
                         POST-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT NO. 1
    
                                       TO
 
                                    FORM S-1
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                            ------------------------
 
                             AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC.
             (EXACT NAME OF REGISTRANT AS SPECIFIED IN ITS CHARTER)
 
                                                                
             DELAWARE                             3674                            23-1722724
 (STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF      (PRIMARY STANDARD INDUSTRIAL             (I.R.S. EMPLOYER
  INCORPORATION OR ORGANIZATION)      CLASSIFICATION CODE NUMBER)           IDENTIFICATION NUMBER)
AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. 1345 ENTERPRISE DRIVE WEST CHESTER, PA 19380 (610) 431-9600 (ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE, OF REGISTRANT'S PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES) FRANK J. MARCUCCI CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. 1345 ENTERPRISE DRIVE WEST CHESTER, PA 19380 (610) 431-9600 (NAME, ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE, OF AGENT FOR SERVICE) Copies to: LARRY W. SONSINI, ESQ. DONNA M. PETKANICS, ESQ. BRUCE M. MCNAMARA, ESQ. WILSON SONSINI GOODRICH & ROSATI PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION 650 PAGE MILL ROAD PALO ALTO, CA 94304 (650) 493-9300 APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement. If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box. [X] If this form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. [ ] If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. [ ] If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. [ ] If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434, please check the following box. [ ] THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A), MAY DETERMINE. ================================================================================ 2 PROSPECTUS LOGO Amkor Technology, Inc. Common Stock ------------------ This Prospectus relates to shares of common stock, par value $.001 per share (the "Common Stock"), of Amkor Technology, Inc., a Delaware corporation ("Amkor" or the "Company") which may be offered and sold by Smith Barney Inc. ("Salomon Smith Barney") in connection with market-making activities in the Company's 5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2003 (the "Convertible Notes"). Salomon Smith Barney may, subject to certain limitations, from time to time borrow Common Stock from certain stockholders of the Company to settle short sales of Common Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Salomon Smith Barney to settle such short sales) entered into by Salomon Smith Barney to hedge any long position in the Convertible Notes resulting from market-making activities. Such sales by Salomon Smith Barney will be made on the Nasdaq National Market or in the over-the-counter market at market prices prevailing at the time of sale or at prices related to such market prices. Salomon Smith Barney is obligated to return such borrowed shares of Common Stock, and shares that have been so returned may be reborrowed and sold. The total number of shares borrowed at any time may not exceed 7,000,000. See "Plan of Distribution." Salomon Smith Barney is not under any obligation to engage in any market-making transactions with respect to the Convertible Notes, and any market-making in the Convertible Notes actually engaged in by Salomon Smith Barney may cease at any time. The Common Stock is listed for trading on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol "AMKR." On May 21, 1998, the last sale price of the Common Stock on the Nasdaq National Market was $ per share. . SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 8 FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN FACTORS THAT SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE PURCHASERS OF SHARES OF COMMON STOCK. ------------------ THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE. May 22, 1998 3 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the "Registration Statement") under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), with respect to the Common Stock offered hereby. This Prospectus does not contain all of the information set forth in the Registration Statement and the exhibits and schedules filed as a part thereof, as permitted by the rules and regulations of the Commission. For further information with respect to the Company and the Common Stock, reference is hereby made to such Registration Statement, including the exhibits and schedules filed as a part thereof. Statements contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other document referred to herein are not necessarily complete and where such contract or other document is an exhibit to the Registration Statement, each such statement is qualified in all respects by the provisions of such exhibit, to which reference is hereby made for a full statement of the provisions thereof. The Registration Statement, including the exhibits and schedules filed as a part thereof, may be inspected without charge at the public reference facilities maintained by the Commission as set forth in the preceding paragraph. Copies of these documents may be obtained at prescribed rates from the Public Reference Section of the Commission at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington. D.C. 20549. The Commission maintains a World Wide Web site that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding registrants that file electronically with the Commission. The address of the Commission's Web site is http://www.sec.gov. PowerQuad(R) and SuperBGA(R) are registered trademarks of the Company and ChipArray(TM), fleXBGA(TM) and PowerSOP(TM) are trademarks of the Company. MicroBGA(TM) is a trademark of Tessera, Inc. This Prospectus includes other trademarks and trade names of the Company and other entities. CERTAIN PERSONS PARTICIPATING IN THE INITIAL PUBLIC OFFERING BY THE COMPANY OF THE COMMON STOCK AND THE CONVERTIBLE NOTES MAY ENGAGE IN TRANSACTIONS THAT STABILIZE, MAINTAIN OR OTHERWISE AFFECT THE PRICE OF THE COMMON STOCK OR THE CONVERTIBLE NOTES, INCLUDING PURCHASES OF SUCH SECURITIES TO STABILIZE THEIR MARKET PRICE, PURCHASES OF SUCH SECURITIES TO COVER SOME OR ALL OF A SHORT POSITION IN SUCH SECURITIES MAINTAINED BY THE UNDERWRITERS OF SUCH OFFERING AND THE IMPOSITION OF PENALTY BIDS. 2 4 PROSPECTUS SUMMARY The following summary is qualified in its entirety by the more detailed information found elsewhere in this Prospectus, including under "Risk Factors" and the Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto. Certain statements contained in "Prospectus Summary," "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business," including statements regarding the anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the Company's anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's expected capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future operating performance, and other statements contained in this Prospectus that are not historical facts, are "forward-looking" statements within the meaning of the U.S. federal securities laws. Because such statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including those set forth in "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business." These forward-looking statements are made as of the date of this Prospectus and the Company assumes no obligation to update such forward-looking statements or to update the reasons why actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements THE COMPANY Amkor is the world's largest independent provider of semiconductor packaging and test services. The Company believes that it is also one of the leading developers of advanced semiconductor packaging and test technology in the industry. The Company offers a complete and integrated set of packaging and test services including integrated circuit ("IC") package design, leadframe and substrate design, IC package assembly, final testing, burn-in, reliability testing, and thermal and electrical characterization. As of December 31, 1997, the Company had in excess of 150 customers, including many of the largest semiconductor companies in the world. Such customers include, among others, Advanced Micro Devices, Inc., International Business Machines Corp., Intel Corporation, Lucent Technologies, Inc., Motorola, Inc., National Semiconductor Corp., Philips Electronics N.V., SGS-THOMSON Microelectronics N.V., Siemens AG and Texas Instruments, Inc. ("TI"). Today, nearly all of the world's major semiconductor companies outsource some or all of their packaging and test needs. The increasing complexities, investment requirements and time to market pressures associated with IC design and production, combined with the growth in the number of ICs being produced and sold, are driving increasing demand for independent packaging and test services. According to industry estimates, independent packaging foundry revenues are expected to grow at a compound annual rate of 16% over a period of five years from $5.6 billion in 1996 to $11.6 billion in 2002. The Company provides packaging and test services through its three factories in the Philippines as well as four factories of Anam Semiconductor, Inc. (formerly Anam Industrial Co., Ltd.) ("AICL") in Korea pursuant to a supply agreement between the Company and AICL. The Company and AICL have had a long- standing relationship. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996 and 1997 were derived from services sold by the Company. Mr. James Kim, the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, is a director of AICL, and he and other members of his family beneficially own approximately 40.7% of AICL's outstanding common stock. The Company expects that the businesses of the Company and AICL will continue to remain highly interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship, overlaps and family ties between their respective shareholders and management, financial relationships, coordination of product and operation plans, joint research and development activities and shared intellectual property rights. The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry capable of producing 15,000 8" wafers per month. Through a strategic relationship with TI, the Company and AICL have qualified .25 micron CMOS process technology, and TI has agreed to provide to AICL .18 micron CMOS process technology during 1998. AICL's foundry will primarily manufacture DSPs, ASICs and other logic devices. By leveraging the Company's leading position in semiconductor packaging and 3 5 test services, the new wafer fabrication services have enabled the Company to become one of the first providers of a fully integrated, turnkey semiconductor fabrication, packaging and test service solution. The Company's strategy is to: (i) maintain its product technology leadership by continuing to design and produce leading-edge packaging technology; (ii) maintain advanced manufacturing capabilities through continuous advancement and refinement of its process technology; (iii) leverage the scale and scope of its packaging and test capabilities to provide Amkor with several competitive advantages, including procurement of key materials and manufacturing equipment, the ability to capitalize on economies of scale and the ability to offer an industry-leading breadth of product offerings; (iv) establish industry packaging standards to bolster sales of leading-edge, high margin and high growth product lines; (v) enhance customer and supplier relationships; (vi) continue to focus on customer support; and (vii) provide an integrated, turnkey solution comprised of wafer fabrication, packaging and test services. The Company was organized under the laws of Delaware in September 1997 to consolidate the ownership of several affiliated entities in the same business and under common management. See "Reorganization." The Company's principal executive offices are located at 1345 Enterprise Drive, West Chester, PA 19380 and its telephone number at that address is (610) 431-9600. THE INITIAL PUBLIC OFFERING On April 30, 1998, the Company commenced the initial public offering of 35,000,000 shares of Common Stock (5,000,000 of which were offered by James Kim, a stockholder of the Company (the "Selling Stockholder")) at a price to the public of $11.00 per share and $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of Convertible Notes (the "Initial Public Offering"). In connection with the Initial Public Offering, the Company granted the underwriters of the Initial Public Offering (the "Underwriters") 30-day options to purchase up to 5,250,000 additional shares of Common Stock and $27,000,000 additional principal amount of Convertible Notes solely to cover over-allotments, if any. These options were exercised in full by the Underwriters. As a result, the Company sold an aggregate of 35,250,000 shares of Common Stock and $207,000,000 of Convertible Notes in the Initial Public Offering. Salomon Smith Barney was a representative of the Underwriters. The net proceeds to the Company from the Initial Public Offering were approximately $559,757,500, after deducting the underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses. The Company did not receive any proceeds from the sale of the shares of Common Stock offered by the Selling Stockholders. Approximately $154 million of the net proceeds to the Company from the Initial Public Offering were used to repay the Non-Compliant Loans (as defined herein), which, following planned repayments of portions thereof prior to the Initial Public Offering, had outstanding balances of $43 million, $50 million and $61 million. These loans were due May 1998, October 2000 and April 2001, respectively, and accrued interest annually at rates equal to 7.16%, 6.78% and 6.68%, respectively, at December 31, 1997, which rates represent LIBOR plus a spread. The $43 million loan was incurred in August 1997 in order to redeem $40 million of Floating Rate Notes issued by Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc., a subsidiary of the Company ("AAP"), and to repay certain short-term debt. The Company was not in compliance with certain covenants under the above-described loans. These loan covenants included restrictions on the ability of one of the Company's subsidiaries to enter into transactions with affiliates, requirements that the subsidiary maintain certain debt-to-equity ratios and requirements that the subsidiary comply with certain notice requirements. As a result of such non- compliance, these loans had been classified as current liabilities in the Company's financial statements included herein, and the report of the Company's independent public accountants with respect to such financial statements previously contained a paragraph stating that there was substantial doubt as to the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern. Repayment of such loans from the proceeds of the Initial Public Offering eliminated these events of non-compliance. Consequently, these loans have been reclassified as non-current liabilities and this paragraph has been deleted from the report of the Company's independent public accountants. 4 6 Approximately $65 million of the net proceeds to the Company from the Initial Public Offering shall be used to repay numerous short-term bank loans incurred primarily to finance capital expenditures for the Company's P1 factory in the Philippines and for working capital. All of these loans were due within 12 months of December 31, 1997 and bore interest at rates ranging from 8.0% to 12.2%. In addition, approximately $8 million of the net proceeds will be used to repay two term loans of approximately $3 million and $5 million. These loans are due September 1999 and January 2001, respectively, and accrue interest annually at rates equal to 9.09% and 11.88%, respectively, at December 31, 1997, which rates represent LIBOR plus a spread. An additional approximately $34 million of the net proceeds to the Company will be used to purchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP. Approximately $86 million of the net proceeds were used to repay all of the amounts due to Anam USA, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of AICL ("AUSA"). The remaining $213 million of such net proceeds will be used for capital expenditures and working capital. Pending such uses, the net proceeds to the Company of the Initial Public Offering have been invested in investment grade, interest-bearing securities. USE OF PROCEEDS This Prospectus relates to the offer and sale of shares of Common Stock whereby Salomon Smith Barney may, subject to certain limitations, from time to time borrow from Mr. James Kim and his wife, Mrs. Agnes Kim ("Mr. and Mrs. Kim"), to settle short sales of Common Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Salomon Smith Barney to settle such short sales) entered into by Salomon Smith Barney to hedge any long position in the Convertible Notes resulting from its market-making activities. See "Plan of Distribution." The Company will not receive any proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock to which this Prospectus relates. RISK FACTORS See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 8 for a discussion of certain factors that should be considered by potential investors. 5 7 SUMMARY COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AND RATIO DATA)
THREE MONTHS YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, ENDED MARCH 31, -------------------------------------------------------- ------------------- 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1997 1998 -------- -------- -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- (UNAUDITED) INCOME STATEMENT DATA: Net revenues.................. $442,101 $572,918 $932,382 $1,171,001 $1,455,761 $313,019 $371,733 Gross profit.................. 70,778 58,270 149,047 148,923 213,092 25,570 61,677 Operating income.............. 26,374 13,843 84,855 71,368 100,841 3,477 30,905 Net income(1)................. 17,236 11,574 61,932 32,922 43,281 (4,829) 8,812 Pro forma adjustment for income taxes(2)............. 2,900 200 10,400 2,900 3,613 1,559 (828) Pro forma net income(2)....... 14,336 11,374 51,532 30,022 39,668 (6,388) 9,640 Basic and diluted pro forma net income per common share....................... .17 .14 .62 .36 .48 (.08) .12 Shares used in per share calculation................. 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 OTHER DATA: EBITDA(3)..................... $ 37,437 $ 34,197 $103,434 $ 123,082 $ 175,111 $ 22,983 $ 51,208 Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(4) Actual...................... 3.7x 2.0x 4.6x 2.4x 2.5x 0.5x 2.4x Supplemental pro forma...... 3.8x
MARCH 31, 1998 ------------------------------------------- DECEMBER 31, 1997 ACTUAL PRO FORMA(5) AS ADJUSTED(6) ----------------- ----------- ------------ -------------- (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) BALANCE SHEET DATA: Cash and cash equivalents.................... $ 90,917 $ 41,989 $ 6,289 $213,816 Working capital (deficit).................... (38,219) (75,626) (111,326) 162,248 Total assets................................. 855,592 786,888 752,688 992,575 Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt............................. 167,317 120,173 120,173 54,126 5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2003....................................... -- -- -- 207,000 Due to AUSA (non-current).................... 149,776 88,280 88,280 -- Other long-term debt......................... 196,934 197,859 197,859 36,756 Stockholders' equity......................... 90,875 100,350 66,150 424,435
- --------------- (1) Net income for 1997 reflects a $17.3 million loss related primarily to the impairment of value of the Company's equity interest in AICL. This investment was sold in 1998. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. (2) Prior to the reorganization of the Company, Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI"), a predecessor of the Company, elected to be taxed as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. Accordingly, AEI did not recognize any provision for federal income tax expense during the periods presented herein. The pro forma adjustment for income taxes reflects the additional U.S. federal income taxes which would have been recorded by the Company if AEI had not been an S Corporation during these periods. See "Reorganization" and Note 1 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. (3) EBITDA is defined as earnings before interest, taxes on income, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is presented here to provide additional information about the Company's ability to meet its future debt service, capital expenditure, and working capital requirements and should not be construed as a substitute for or a better indicator of results of operations or liquidity than net income or cash flow from operating activities computed in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. (4) For purposes of calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of income before income taxes less undistributed earnings in less than 50%-owned subsidiaries, plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of interest expense incurred and one-third of rental expense which amount is deemed by the Company to be representative of the interest factor of rental payments under operating leases. The supplemental pro forma ratio of earnings to fixed charges reflects the effect on the ratio of earnings to fixed charges as if the Initial Public Offering had been completed and the net proceeds to the Company applied as described in "-- The Initial Public Offering" at the beginning of the period presented. (5) Pro forma balance sheet data reflects (i) the termination of AEI's S Corporation status which resulted in the recording of a deferred tax asset of $1.5 million and (ii) a distribution by the Company of undistributed earnings of AEI through March 31, 1998 of $35.7 million to stockholders of AEI prior to the reorganization of the Company. The amount actually distributed by the Company to such stockholders of AEI will reflect the amount of undistributed net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor Technology, Inc. following March 31, 1998 and prior to such reorganization. See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status and Distributions" and Notes 1, 16 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 6 8 (6) As adjusted to give effect to the application of the net proceeds to the Company of the Initial Public Offering, including the purchase from AICL of its 40% interest in AAP for approximately $34 million and the related elimination of minority interest and recording of goodwill. The acquisition of the minority interest will result in additional amortization of approximately $2.5 million per year. Also reflects repayments made after March 31, 1998 and prior to the Initial Public Offering of $2.5 million of amounts due to AUSA (non-current) and the purchase of AK Industries, Inc. for $3 million. See "-- The Initial Public Offering," "Reorganization" and Notes 1, 6 and 16 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Capitalized terms used in this summary have the meanings ascribed to such terms elsewhere in this Prospectus. Unless the context otherwise requires, all references in this Prospectus to the "Company" or "Amkor" are to Amkor Technology, Inc. and its subsidiaries. Prior to the Reorganization (as defined under "Reorganization"), such subsidiaries were under common management and were in the same business. As a result, the financial statements presented herein have been prepared on a combined basis. Unless otherwise indicated, all information in this Prospectus gives effect to (i) the Reorganization which was consummated on April 29, 1998, including the issuance of 82,610,000 shares of Common Stock in connection therewith, and (ii) the Initial Public Offering and the application of the net proceeds therefrom. See "-- The Initial Public Offering," "Reorganization," "Description of Capital Stock" and Note 1 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. References in this Prospectus to "Korea" are to the Republic of Korea, and references to "won" or "W" are to the currency of the Republic of Korea. The won has depreciated significantly against the U.S. dollar and other foreign currencies in recent months. On May 14, 1998, the base rate under the market average exchange rate system, as announced by the Korea Financial Telecommunications and Clearings Institute in Seoul, Korea (the "Market Average Exchange Rate"), was W1,418 to $1.00. No representation is made that the won or U.S. dollar amounts referred to herein could have been or could be converted into U.S. dollars or won, as the case may be, at any particular rate or at all. Financial information for AICL contained in this Prospectus has been prepared on the basis of Korean generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP"), which differ in certain significant respects from U.S. GAAP. Certain technical terms used throughout this Prospectus are defined in the Glossary appearing immediately prior to the Combined Financial Statements at the end of this Prospectus. 7 9 RISK FACTORS Prospective investors should consider carefully the following risk factors, in addition to the other information contained in this Prospectus concerning the Company and its business, before purchasing the shares of Common Stock or the Convertible Notes offered hereby. Certain statements contained in "Prospectus Summary," "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business," including statements regarding the anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the Company's anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's expected capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future operating performance and other statements contained in this Prospectus that are not historical facts, are "forward-looking" statements within the meaning of the U.S. federal securities laws. Because such statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including those set forth herein and in "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business." These forward-looking statements are made as of the date of this Prospectus and the Company assumes no obligation to update such forward-looking statements or to update the reasons why actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements. FLUCTUATIONS IN OPERATING RESULTS; DECLINES IN AVERAGE SELLING PRICES The Company's operating results have varied significantly from period to period. A variety of factors could materially and adversely affect the Company's revenues, gross profit and operating income, or lead to significant variability of quarterly or annual operating results. These factors include, among others, the cyclical nature of both the semiconductor industry and the markets addressed by end-users of semiconductors, the short-term nature of its customers' commitments, timing and volume of orders relative to the Company's production capacity, changes in capacity utilization, evolutions in the life cycles of customers' products, rescheduling and cancellation of large orders, rapid erosion of packaging selling prices, availability of manufacturing capacity, allocation of production capacity between the Company's facilities and those of AICL, fluctuations in package and test service charges paid to AICL, changes in costs, availability and delivery times of labor, raw materials and components, effectiveness in managing production processes, fluctuations in manufacturing yields, changes in product mix, product obsolescence, timing of expenditures in anticipation of future orders, availability of financing for expansion, changes in interest expense, the ability to develop and implement new technologies on a timely basis, competitive factors, changes in effective tax rates, the loss of key personnel or the shortage of available skilled workers, international political or economic events, currency and interest rate fluctuations, environmental events, and intellectual property transactions and disputes. Unfavorable changes in any of the above factors may adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, the Company increases its level of operating expenses and investment in manufacturing capacity based on anticipated future growth in revenues. If the Company's revenues do not grow as anticipated and the Company is not able to decrease its expenses, the Company's business, financial condition and operating results would be materially and adversely affected. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." Beginning in the third quarter of 1996, intense competition in the semiconductor industry worldwide resulted in decreases in the average selling prices of many of the Company's lead frame packages. The Company expects that average selling prices for its services will continue to decline in the future, principally due to intense competitive conditions. A decline in average selling prices of the Company's services, if not offset by reductions in the cost of producing those services or by a shift to higher margin products, would decrease the Company's gross margins and could materially and adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." DEPENDENCE ON THE HIGHLY CYCLICAL SEMICONDUCTOR AND PERSONAL COMPUTER INDUSTRIES The Company's business is substantially affected by market conditions in the semiconductor industry, which is highly cyclical and, at various times, has been subject to significant economic downturns character- 8 10 ized by reduced product demand, rapid erosion of average selling prices and production overcapacity. In addition, the markets for semiconductors are characterized by rapid technological change, evolving industry standards, intense competition and fluctuations in end-user demand. Because the Company's business will be dependent on the requirements of semiconductor companies for independent packaging, test and wafer fabrication services for the foreseeable future, any future downturn in the semiconductor industry could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company's operating results for 1996, 1997 and the first three months of 1998 were adversely affected by a downturn in the semiconductor market. In addition, a significant portion of the Company's net revenues from packaging and test services depends on the packaging and testing of semiconductors used in personal computer ("PC") products. The PC industry is subject to intense competition, is highly volatile and is subject to significant shifts in demand. As a result, any deterioration of business conditions in the PC industry could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business -- Industry Background" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH LEVERAGE The Company has historically operated with significant amounts of debt relative to its equity. At March 31, 1998, the Company had outstanding $406.3 million in principal amount of indebtedness, including non-current amounts due to Anam USA, Inc. ("AUSA"), a wholly-owned subsidiary of AICL, and the Company has incurred prior to the Initial Public Offering and intends to continue to incur additional bank debt in addition to the Convertible Notes issued as part of the Initial Public Offering. In 1996 and 1997, the Company's payments under long-term debt agreements (excluding payments to AUSA as described in Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements) were $3.1 million and $43.5 million, respectively. Following the application of the net proceeds to the Company of the Initial Public Offering and repayments of debt after December 31, 1997 and prior to the Initial Public Offering, the Company will continue to have at least $298 million in principal amount of indebtedness outstanding, including $54 million of short-term borrowings and current portions of long-term debt. The Company was not in compliance with certain covenants with respect to certain of its loans, the aggregate outstanding amount of which was $154 million at March 31, 1998 (the "Non-Compliant Loans"). Such non-compliance in turn triggered cross-defaults with respect to an additional $10 million of the Company's loans. These loan covenants included restrictions on the ability of one of the Company's subsidiaries to enter into transactions with affiliates, requirements that the subsidiary maintain certain debt-to-equity ratios and requirements that the subsidiary comply with certain notice requirements. As a result of such non-compliance, these loans had been classified as current liabilities in the Company's financial statements included herein, and the report of the Company's independent public accountants with respect to such financial statements previously contained a paragraph stating that there was substantial doubt as to the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern. The Company has eliminated such non-compliance and cross-defaults by repaying such loans using part of the net proceeds to the Company from the Initial Public Offering. Consequently, these loans have been classified as non-current liabilities and this paragraph has been deleted from the report of the Company's independent public accountants. See "Prospectus Summary -- The Initial Public Offering." At March 31, 1998, the Company had also guaranteed borrowing facilities available to companies affiliated with James Kim and other stockholders of the Company totalling $10.7 million, of which $9.5 million was outstanding at March 31, 1998. At March 31, 1998, the Company had $100.4 million of stockholders' equity and a working capital deficit of $75.6 million. On a pro forma basis, after giving effect to the termination of AEI's S Corporation status and the distribution of undistributed net income of AEI through March 31, 1998, the Company had $66.2 million of stockholders' equity and a working capital deficit of $111.3 million. On a pro forma as-adjusted basis, after giving effect to the Initial Public Offering, the Company had $424.4 million of stockholders equity and working capital of $162.2 million. See "-- Dependence on International Operations and Sales; Concentration of Operations in the Philippines and Korea" and "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status and Distributions." 9 11 DEPENDENCE ON RELATIONSHIP WITH AICL; POTENTIAL CONFLICTS OF INTEREST AICL was founded in 1956 by Mr. H. S. Kim, who currently serves as the honorary Chairman and a Representative Director of AICL. AICL is a member of the Anam group of companies (the "Anam Group"), consisting principally of companies in Korea in the electronics industries. The management of AICL and the other companies in the Anam Group are influenced to a significant degree by the family of H. S. Kim, which, together with the Company, collectively owned approximately 40.7% of the outstanding common stock of AICL as of December 31, 1997. A significant portion of the shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or for other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. James Kim, the founder of the Company and currently its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, is the eldest son of H. S. Kim. Since January 1992, in addition to his other responsibilities, James Kim has been serving as acting Chairman of the Anam Group and a director of AICL. Mr. In-Kil Hwang, the President and a Representative Director of AICL, is the brother-in-law of James Kim. In addition, four other members of Mr. Kim's family are on the 13-member Board of Directors of AICL. After the Initial Public Offering, James Kim and members of his family beneficially owned approximately 65.8% of the outstanding Common Stock of the Company, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise significant control over the Company. See "-- Benefits of the Initial Public Offering to Existing Stockholders; Continued Control by Existing Stockholders" and "Principal Stockholders." The businesses of the Company and AICL have been interdependent for many years. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998 were derived from services sold by the Company. The Company expects the proportion of its revenues derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL and the proportion of AICL's revenues from services sold by the Company to increase as the Company begins selling the wafer fabrication output of AICL's new wafer foundry and with the Company's assumption from AICL in January 1998 of substantially all of the marketing rights for the Japanese market. In the event the ability of AICL to supply the Company were disrupted for any reason, the Company's facilities in the Philippines would be able to fill only a small portion of the resulting shortfall in capacity. In addition, there are currently no significant third party suppliers of packaging and test services from which the Company could fill its orders. As a result, the Company's business, financial condition and operating results will continue to be significantly dependent on the ability of AICL to effectively provide contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely basis. The termination of the Company's relationship with AICL for any reason, or any material adverse change in AICL's business resulting from underutilization of its capacity, the level of its debt and its guarantees of affiliate debt, labor disruptions, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates, changes in governmental policies, economic or political conditions in Korea or any other change, could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company has recently entered into new supply agreements with AICL (the "Supply Agreements"). Under the Supply Agreements, AICL has granted to the Company a first right to substantially all of the packaging and test services capacity of AICL and the exclusive right to all of the wafer output of its new wafer foundry. The Company expects to continue to purchase substantially all of AICL's packaging and test services, and to purchase all of AICL's wafer output, under the Supply Agreements. Under the Supply Agreements, pricing arrangements relating to packaging and test services provided by AICL to the Company are subject to quarterly review and adjustment, and such arrangements relating to the wafer output provided by AICL to the Company are subject to annual review and adjustment, in each case on the basis of factors such as changes in the semiconductor market, forecasted demand, product mix, capacity utilization and fluctuations in exchange rates, as well as the mutual long-term strategic interests of the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that any new pricing arrangements resulting from such review and adjustment will be favorable to the Company. Pursuant to long-standing arrangements between AICL and the Company's operating subsidiaries, sales from AICL to the Company will continue to be made through AUSA, a wholly-owned financing subsidiary of AICL. Under the Supply Agreements, the Company will continue to reimburse AUSA for the financing costs incurred by it in connection with trade financing provided to the Company. The Supply Agreements also provide that Amkor-Anam, Inc., a subsidiary of the Company, will continue to provide raw material procurement and related 10 12 services to AICL on a fee basis. The Supply Agreements have a five-year term and may be terminated by any party thereto upon five years' written notice at any time after the expiration of such initial five-year term. There can be no assurance that AICL will not terminate either Supply Agreement upon the expiration of such initial term or, if it does terminate a Supply Agreement, that the Company will be able to obtain a new agreement with AICL on terms that are favorable to the Company or at all. AICL's ability to continue to provide services to the Company will depend on AICL's financial condition and performance. AICL currently has a significant amount of debt relative to its equity, which debt the Company expects will continue to increase in the foreseeable future. The Company is advised that AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 1997. These consolidated financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP, which differs significantly from U.S. GAAP. U.S. GAAP financial statements are not available. The independent auditor's report regarding AICL, included elsewhere in this Prospectus, includes an explanatory paragraph regarding change in accounting principles, the impact of the Korean economic situation on AICL and its ability to continue as a going concern.
1996 1997 ---------- -------------- (IN MILLIONS) INCOME STATEMENT DATA: Sales.................................................. W1,338,718 W1,786,457 Cost of sales.......................................... 1,096,117 1,507,271 ---------- ---------- Gross profit........................................... 242,601 279,186 Selling and administrative expenses.................... 77,754 103,158 ---------- ---------- Operating income....................................... 164,847 176,028 Non-operating income: Interest and dividend income........................ 38,569 47,592 Foreign exchange gains.............................. 10,420 122,507 Other............................................... 9,268 11,196 ---------- ---------- 58,257 181,295 ---------- ---------- Non-operating expenses: Interest expenses................................... 138,657 160,658 Amortization of deferred charges.................... 2,861 33,891 Foreign exchange losses............................. 39,792 339,204 Loss from forward contract.......................... -- 94,644 Other............................................... 9,962 20,639 ---------- ---------- 191,272 649,036 ---------- ---------- Ordinary income (loss)................................. 31,832 (291,713) Extraordinary gains.................................... 447 774 Extraordinary losses................................... 11,072 1,812 ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) before income taxes.................. 21,207 (292,751) Income taxes........................................... 17,363 7,922 ---------- ---------- Net income (loss) after income taxes................... 3,844 (300,673) Minority interests in losses (earnings) of consolidated subsidiaries, net................................... (8,569) 1,206 Amortization of consolidation adjustments, net......... (5,326) (3,009) Equity in earnings (losses) of unconsolidated equity-method subsidiaries and investees, net....... 666 (46,253) ---------- ---------- Net loss............................................... W (9,385) W (348,729) ========== ==========
11 13
1996 1997 ---------- -------------- (IN MILLIONS) SUMMARY BALANCE SHEET DATA: Cash and bank deposits................................. W 324,139 W 215,024 Accounts and notes receivable, net..................... 170,724 189,522 Inventory.............................................. 214,494 260,302 Other current assets................................... 145,302 241,965 ---------- ---------- Total current assets................................ 854,659 906,813 ---------- ---------- Property, plant and equipment, net..................... 994,931 2,159,466 Investments............................................ 83,715 121,880 Long-term accounts receivable.......................... 198,251 203,739 Long-term loans........................................ 747 258,322 Other long-term assets................................. 92,985 285,810 ---------- ---------- Total long-term assets.............................. 1,370,629 3,029,217 ---------- ---------- Total assets................................... W2,225,288 W3,936,030 ========== ========== Short-term borrowings.................................. 1,050,405 1,720,916 Current maturities of long-term debt................... 85,252 120,913 Other current liabilities.............................. 190,989 282,653 ---------- ---------- Total current liabilities........................... 1,326,646 2,124,482 ---------- ---------- Long-term debt, net of current maturities.............. 475,045 736,784 Long-term capital lease obligations.................... 106,068 861,813 Other long-term liabilities............................ 67,672 111,017 ---------- ---------- Total long-term liabilities......................... 648,785 1,709,614 ---------- ---------- Total liabilities.............................. 1,975,431 3,834,096 ---------- ---------- Minority interests..................................... 21,600 25,160 Stockholders' equity................................... 228,257 76,774 ---------- ---------- Total liabilities and stockholders' equity..... W2,225,288 W3,936,030 ========== ==========
A significant amount of the current and long-term liabilities of AICL are denominated in U.S. dollars and other foreign currencies. At December 31, 1997, the amount of U.S. dollar and other foreign currency denominated short-term borrowings, current maturities of long-term debt, long-term debt (net of current maturities) and long-term capital lease obligations were W1,222 billion, W59 billion, W159 billion and W834 billion, respectively. Due in part to the significant depreciation of the won (for example, from a Market Average Exchange Rate of W884 to $1.00 on December 31, 1996 to W1,415 to $1.00 on December 31, 1997 and W1,418 to $1.00 on May 14, 1998) resulting from the recent economic crisis in Korea, AICL's liabilities in won terms and its leverage calculated in won have significantly increased in 1997. The effect of this depreciation on AICL, however, has been mitigated by the fact that substantial amounts of AICL's revenues are denominated in U.S. dollars. The increase in AICL's liabilities was also attributable in part to additional financing obtained in connection with the construction of its new wafer foundry. See "-- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The recent economic crisis in Korea has also led to sharply higher interest rates in Korea and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding maturing debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing financial difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending, particularly to highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and provisions for non-performing assets. These developments will result in higher interest rates on loans to AICL and have otherwise made it more difficult for AICL to obtain new financing. Therefore, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to refinance its existing loans or obtain new loans, or continue to make required interest and principal payments on such loans or otherwise comply with the terms of its loan agreements. Any inability of AICL to obtain financing or generate cash flow from operations sufficient to fund its capital expenditure, debt service and repayment and other working capital and liquidity requirements could have a material adverse effect on AICL's ability to continue to provide services and otherwise fulfill its obligations to the Company. See "-- Risks Associated with Leverage" and "-- Dependence on International Operations and Sales; Concentration of Operations in the Philippines and Korea." 12 14 As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries were contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of AICL's non-consolidated subsidiaries and affiliates in the Anam Group in the aggregate amount of approximately W857 billion. As of such date, AICL had provided guarantees for all of AUSA's debt of $319 million, the Non-Compliant Loans of $176 million and the Company's obligations under a receivables sales arrangement. The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs through financing arrangements obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company based on guarantees provided by AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. Further, a deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. In addition, as an overseas subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their financing needs through alternative arrangements. Although the Company believes that alternative financing arrangements will be available in the future, there can be no assurance that the Company or AICL will be able to obtain alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. In addition, if any relevant subsidiaries or affiliates of AICL, certain of which may have greater exposure to domestic Korean economic conditions than AICL, were to fail to make interest or principal payments or otherwise default under their debt obligations guaranteed by AICL, AICL could be required under its guarantees to repay such debt, which event could have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations. Historically, AICL has undertaken capacity expansion programs and other capital expenditures primarily on the basis of forecasts of the Company and business plans prepared jointly with the Company. The Supply Agreements generally provide for continued capital investment by AICL based on the Company's forecasts and operational plans prepared jointly by the Company and AICL reflecting such forecasts. However, as a result of the recent deterioration of the Korean economy, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to fund future capacity expansions and other capital investments required to supply the Company with necessary packaging and test services and wafer output on a timely and cost-efficient basis. The Company and AICL have historically cooperated on the development of new package designs and packaging and testing processes and technologies. The Supply Agreements generally provide for continued cooperation between the Company and AICL in research and development, as well as the cross-licensing of intellectual property rights between the Company and AICL. If the Company's relationship with AICL were terminated for any reason, the Company's research and development capabilities and intellectual property position could be materially and adversely affected. The Company will continue to be controlled to a significant degree by James Kim and members of his family for the foreseeable future, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will also continue to exercise significant influence over the management of AICL and its affiliates. In addition, the Company and AICL will continue to have certain contractual and other business relationships, including under the Supply Agreements, and may engage in transactions from time to time that are material to the Company. Although any such material agreements and transactions would require approval of the Company's Board of Directors, such transactions generally will not require any additional approval by a separate committee comprised of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors and conflicts of interest may arise in certain circumstances. There can be no assurance that such conflicts will not from time to time be resolved against the interests of the Company. The Company currently has four directors, two of whom are disinterested. Under Delaware corporate law, each director owes a duty of loyalty and care to the Company, which if breached can result in personal liability for the directors. In addition, the Company may agree to certain changes in its contractual and other business relationships with AICL, including pricing, manufacturing allocation, capacity utilization and capacity expansion, among others, which in the judgment of the Company's management will result in reduced short-term profitability for the Company in favor of potential long-term benefits to the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that the Company's business, financial condition or results of operations will not be adversely affected by any such decision. 13 15 DEPENDENCE ON INTERNATIONAL OPERATIONS AND SALES; CONCENTRATION OF OPERATIONS IN THE PHILIPPINES AND KOREA All of the production facilities currently used to fill the Company's orders are located in the Philippines and Korea and many of the Company's customers' operations are located in countries outside of the United States. A substantial portion of the Company's revenues are derived from sales to customers located outside of the United States. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, sales to such customers accounted for 27%, 28% and 31%, respectively, of the Company's revenues. The Company expects sales outside of the United States to continue to represent a significant portion of its future revenues. As a result, the Company's business will continue to be subject to certain risks generally associated with doing business abroad, such as foreign governmental regulations, currency fluctuations, political unrest, disruptions or delays in shipments, currency controls and fluctuations, changes in local economic conditions and import and export controls, as well as changes in tax laws, tariffs and freight rates. The Company has structured its global operations to take advantage of lower tax rates in certain countries and tax incentives extended to encourage investment. The Company's tax returns through 1993 in the Philippines and through 1994 in the U.S. have been examined by the Philippine and U.S. tax authorities, respectively. The recorded provisions for subsequent open years are subject to changes upon examination by tax authorities of tax returns for these years. Changes in the mix of income from the Company's foreign subsidiaries, expiration of tax holidays and changes in tax laws and regulations could result in increased effective tax rates for the Company. See Notes 10 and 15 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Philippines The Company's results of operations and growth will be influenced by the political situation in the Philippines and by the general state of the Philippine economy. Although the political and economic situation in the Philippines has stabilized in recent years, it has historically been subject to significant instability. Most recently, the devaluation of the Philippine peso relative to the U.S. dollar beginning in July 1997 has led to instability in the Philippine economy. Any future economic or political disruptions or instability or low economic growth in the Philippines could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. Because the functional currency of the Company's Philippine operations is the U.S. dollar, the Company has recently benefitted from cost reductions relating to peso denominated expenditures, primarily payroll costs. The Company believes that such devaluation of the Philippine peso will eventually lead to inflation in the Philippines, which could offset any savings achieved to date. Korea In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL. The operations of AICL are subject to certain risks. Relations between Korea and the Democratic People's Republic of Korea ("North Korea") have been tense over most of Korea's history. Incidents affecting relations between the two Koreas continually occur. No assurance can be given that the level of tensions with North Korea will not increase or change abruptly as a result of current or future events, which could have a material adverse effect on AICL's, and as a result the Company's, business, financial condition and results of operations. Since the beginning of 1997, Korea has experienced a significant increase in the number and size of companies filing for corporate reorganization and protection from their creditors. Such failures were caused by, among other factors, excessive investments, high levels of indebtedness, weak export prices and the Korean government's greater willingness to allow troubled corporations to fail. As a result of such corporate failures, Korea's financial institutions have experienced a sharp increase in non-performing loans. In addition, declines in domestic stock prices have reduced the value of Korean banks' assets. These developments have led international credit rating agencies to downgrade the credit ratings of Korea, as well as various companies (including AICL) and financial institutions in Korea. During the same period, the value of the won relative to the U.S. dollar has depreciated significantly. The Market Average Exchange Rate as of May 14, 1998 was W1,418 to $1.00, as compared to the December 31, 14 16 1996 Market Average Exchange Rate of W884 to $1.00. Such depreciation of the won relative to the U.S. dollar has increased the cost of imported goods and services, and the value in won of Korea's public and private sector debt denominated in U.S. dollars and other foreign currencies has also increased significantly. Korea's foreign currency reserves also have declined significantly. Such developments have also led to sharply higher domestic interest rates and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding maturing debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing financial difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending, in particular to highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and provisions for non-performing assets. In order to address the liquidity crisis and the deteriorating economic situation in Korea, the Korean government concluded an agreement with the International Monetary Fund on December 3, 1997 pursuant to which Korea is eligible to receive loans and other financial support reported to amount to an aggregate of approximately $58 billion (the "IMF Financial Aid Package"). Because there are conditions on the availability of loans and other financial support under the IMF Financial Aid Package, there can be no assurance that such conditions will be satisfied or that such loans and other financial support will be available. In connection with the IMF Financial Aid Package, the Korean government announced a comprehensive policy package (the "Reform Policy") intended to address the structural weaknesses in the Korean economy and the financial sector. While the Reform Policy is intended to alleviate the current economic crisis in Korea and improve the Korean economy over time, the immediate effects could include, among others, slower economic growth, a reduction in the availability of credit to Korean companies, an increase in interest rates, an increase in taxes, an increased rate of inflation due to the depreciation of the won, an increase in the number of bankruptcies of Korean companies, labor unrest and labor strikes resulting from a possible increase in unemployment, and political unrest. These events could have a material adverse effect on the Korean economy. Moreover, there can be no assurance that either the IMF Financial Aid Package or the Reform Policy will be successful. In addition, there can be no assurance that political pressure will not force the Korean government to retreat from some or all of its announced Reform Policy or that the Reform Policy will be implemented as currently contemplated. The Korean government has stated that as of December 31, 1997 the total amount of Korea's private and governmental external liabilities was $154.4 billion under IMF standards. As of December 31, 1997, the total amount of foreign currency reserves held by Korea was $20.4 billion, of which the usable portion (the total less amounts on deposit with overseas branches of Korean financial institutions and swap positions between the Korean central bank and other central banks) was $8.9 billion. Pursuant to an exchange offer concluded in April 1998, the Korean financial institutions exchanged approximately $21.8 billion of their short-term foreign currency debt for longer term floating rate loans guaranteed by the Korean government. In addition, the Korean government raised approximately $4 billion through an international offering of its debt securities in April 1998. Korean financial institutions and the Korean corporate and public sectors continue to carry substantial amounts of debt denominated in currencies other than the won, including short-term debt, and there can be no assurance that there will be sufficient foreign currency reserves to repay this debt or that this debt can be extended or refinanced. Such recent and potential future developments relating to Korea, including the continued deterioration of the Korean economy, could have a material adverse effect on AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "-- Dependence on Relationship with AICL; Potential Conflicts of Interest," "Business -- Marketing and Sales" and "-- Facilities and Manufacturing" and Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. CUSTOMER CONCENTRATION; ABSENCE OF BACKLOG Due to the concentration of market share in the semiconductor industry, the Company has been largely dependent on a small group of customers for a substantial portion of its business. In 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, 34.1%, 39.2%, 40.1% and 34.9%, respectively, of the Company's net revenues were derived from sales to the Company's top five customers, with 13.3%, 23.5%, 23.4% and 19.2% of the Company's net revenues, respectively, derived from sales to Intel Corporation ("Intel"). The ability of the Company to maintain close, satisfactory relationships with such customers is important to the ongoing success 15 17 and profitability of its business. The Company expects that it will continue to be dependent upon a relatively limited number of customers for a significant portion of its net revenues in future periods. None of the Company's customers is presently obligated to purchase any amount of packaging or test services or to provide the Company with binding forecasts of product purchases for any period. In addition, the Company's new wafer fabrication business will be significantly dependent upon TI. The reduction, delay, or cancellation of orders from one of the Company's significant customers, including Intel for packaging and test services or TI for wafer fabrication services, could materially and adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. Although the Company has received forecasts from TI which indicate that TI will meet its minimum purchase obligation during the second half of 1998, during the first quarter of 1998 TI's orders were below such minimum purchase commitment due to market conditions and issues encountered by TI in the transition of its products to .18 micron technology. There can be no assurance that such customers will not reduce, cancel or delay orders. See "-- Dependence on the Highly Cyclical Semiconductor and Personal Computer Industries" and "-- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business." All of the Company's customers operate in the cyclical semiconductor business and may vary order levels significantly from period to period. In addition, there can be no assurance that such customers or any other customers will continue to place orders with the Company in the future at the same levels as in prior periods. From time to time, semiconductor companies have experienced reduced prices for some products, as well as delays or cancellations in orders. There can be no assurance that, should these circumstances occur in the future, they will not adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The loss of one or more of the Company's customers, or reduced orders by any of its key customers, could adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company's packaging and test business does not typically operate with any material backlog, and the Company expects that in the future the Company's packaging and test revenues in any quarter will continue to be substantially dependent upon orders received in that quarter. The Company's expense levels are based in part on its expectations of future revenues and the Company may be unable to adjust costs in a timely manner to compensate for any revenue shortfall. See "Business -- Marketing and Sales." EXPANSION OF MANUFACTURING CAPACITY; PROFITABILITY AFFECTED BY CAPACITY UTILIZATION RATES The Company believes that its competitive position depends substantially on its ability to expand its manufacturing capacity. Accordingly, although the Company currently has available manufacturing capacity, the Company expects to continue to make significant investments to expand such capacity, particularly through the acquisition of capital equipment and the training of new personnel. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to utilize such capacity or to continue to expand its manufacturing capacity in a timely manner, that the cost of such expansion will not exceed management's current estimates or that such capacity will not exceed the demand for the Company's services. In addition, expansion of the Company's manufacturing capacity will continue to significantly increase its fixed costs, and the Company expects to continue to incur substantial additional depreciation and other expenses in connection with the acquisition of new equipment and the construction of new facilities. Increases or decreases in capacity utilization rates can have a significant effect on gross margins since the unit cost of packaging and test services generally decreases as fixed charges are allocated over a larger number of units produced. Therefore, the Company's ability to maintain or enhance its gross margins will continue to be dependent, in part, on its ability to maintain high capacity utilization rates. Capacity utilization rates may be affected by a number of factors and circumstances, including overall industry conditions, operating efficiencies, the level of customer orders, mechanical failure, disruption of operations due to expansion of operations or relocation of equipment, fire or natural disasters, employee strikes or work stoppages or other circumstances. Although the Company has been able to maintain a high rate of capacity utilization in recent years as a result of its close association with its customers, its knowledge of the semiconductor market conditions, and its continued improvements in operating efficiencies and equipment maintenance, there can be no assurance that this high utilization rate will be sustained in the future. The Company's inability to generate the additional orders necessary to fully utilize its capacity would have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. For example, 16 18 in 1996 the Company's capacity utilization rates were negatively affected by an unexpected downturn in the semiconductor industry. There can be no assurance that the Company's utilization rates will not be adversely affected by future declines in the semiconductor industry or for any other reason. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business -- Manufacturing and Facilities." LIQUIDITY AND FUTURE CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS The Company plans to continue to incur substantial costs to fund its equipment and facilities expansion plans and its packaging technology development. The Company believes that following the application of the net proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock and the Convertible Notes in the Initial Public Offering, its existing cash balances, cash flow from operations, available equipment lease financing, bank borrowings and financing obtained through AUSA, will be sufficient to meet its projected capital expenditures, working capital and other cash requirements for at least the next twelve months. There can be no assurance, however, that lower than expected revenues, increased expenses, increased costs associated with the purchase or maintenance of capital equipment, decisions to increase planned capacity or other events will not cause the Company to seek more capital, or capital sooner than currently expected. The timing and amount of the Company's actual capital requirements cannot be precisely determined and will depend on a number of factors, including demand for the Company's services, availability of capital equipment, fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates, changes in semiconductor industry conditions and competitive factors. There can be no assurance that additional financing will be available when needed or, if available, will be available on satisfactory terms. Failure to obtain any such financing could have a material adverse effect on the Company. In addition, if the Company obtains such financing by selling equity securities of the Company, the Company's stockholders may experience significant dilution. See "-- Risks Associated with Leverage" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources." RAPID TECHNOLOGICAL CHANGE; PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT The semiconductor packaging and test industry is characterized by rapid increases in the diversity and complexity of semiconductor packaging products. As a result, the Company expects that it will need to offer, on an ongoing basis, more advanced package designs in order to respond to competitive industry conditions and customer requirements. The requirement to develop and maintain advanced packaging capabilities and equipment could require significant research and development and capital expenditures in future years. In addition, advances in technology also typically lead to rapid and significant price erosion and decreased margins for older package types and may lead to products currently being offered by the Company becoming less competitive or inventories held by the Company becoming obsolete. The failure by the Company to achieve advances in package design or to obtain access to advanced package designs developed by others could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, results of operations and financial condition. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." The Company's success is also dependent upon the ability of it and AICL to develop and implement new manufacturing process and package design technologies. Semiconductor package design and process methodologies have become increasingly subject to technological change, requiring large expenditures for research and development. Converting to new package designs or process methodologies could result in delays in producing new package types which could adversely affect the Company's ability to meet customer orders. MANUFACTURING RISKS; PRODUCTION YIELDS The semiconductor packaging process is complex and involves a number of precise steps. Defective packaging can result from a number of factors, including the level of contaminants in the manufacturing environment, human error, equipment malfunction, use of defective raw materials, defective plating services and inadequate sample testing. From time to time, the Company expects to experience lower than anticipated production yields as a result of such factors, particularly in connection with any expansion of its capacity or change in its processing steps. In addition, the Company's yield on new products will be lower during the 17 19 period necessary for the Company to develop the requisite expertise and experience in producing such products and using such processes. The failure of the Company or AICL to maintain high quality production standards or acceptable production yields, if significant and sustained, could result in loss of customers, delays in shipments, increased costs, cancellation of orders and product returns for rework, any of which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "Business -- Facilities and Manufacturing." RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH NEW WAFER FABRICATION BUSINESS The Company recently began providing wafer fabrication services, with delivery of the first products from AICL's new foundry in January 1998. Neither the Company nor AICL has significant experience in providing wafer fabrication services, and there can be no assurance that the Company will not experience difficulties in marketing and selling these services or that AICL will not encounter operational difficulties such as lower than expected yields or longer than anticipated production ramp-up, unexpected costs and other problems in providing these services. If the Company or AICL encounters these or similar difficulties, the Company's and AICL's businesses, financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected. In addition, TI has transferred certain of its CMOS processes to AICL and AICL is dependent upon TI's assistance for developing other state-of-the-art wafer manufacturing processes. If AICL's relationship with TI is disrupted for any reason, AICL's ability to produce wafers would be adversely affected, thus negatively impacting the Company's ability to fulfill its customers' orders for fabrication services, which could materially and adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, AICL's technology agreements with TI (the "TI Technology Agreements") only cover .25 micron and .18 micron CMOS technology and TI is not under any obligation to transfer any next-generation technology. If AICL is not able to obtain such technology on commercially reasonable terms or at all, the Company's ability to market AICL's wafer fabrication services could be materially and adversely affected which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's and AICL's business, results of operations and financial condition. The Company's right to the supply of wafers from AICL's foundry is subject to an agreement (the "TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement") among AICL, the Company and TI, pursuant to which TI has agreed to purchase from the Company at least 40% of the capacity of this foundry and under certain circumstances has the right to purchase up to 70% of this capacity. As a result, the Company's wafer fabrication business will be significantly dependent upon TI, which may adversely affect the Company's ability to obtain additional customers. If the Company is unable to sell substantially all of the output of AICL's wafer foundry, its business, results of operations and financial condition could be materially and adversely affected. Although the Company has received forecasts from TI which indicate that TI will meet its minimum purchase obligation during the second half of 1998, during the first quarter of 1998 TI's orders were below such minimum purchase commitment and it is uncertain whether TI will meet its purchase obligations in the second quarter of 1998 due to market conditions and issues encountered by TI in the transition of its products to .18 micron technology. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that TI will place orders representing at least 40% of the capacity of this foundry during this period or in the future. A failure by TI to comply with its minimum purchase obligations or the cancellation of a significant wafer fabrication order by TI or any other customer could have a material adverse effect on AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement terminates on December 31, 2007, unless terminated sooner. The TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement may be terminated upon two years' prior notice by either AICL or TI if AICL and TI are unable to successfully negotiate prior to June 30, 2000 an amendment to the TI Technology Agreements or a new agreement with respect to AICL's use of TI's next-generation CMOS technology. During such two-year period, TI would be obligated to purchase a minimum of only 20% of the capacity of AICL's wafer fabrication facility. In addition, the TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement may be terminated sooner upon, among other events, mutual written consent, material breach of the agreement by either party, the inability of either party to obtain any necessary government approvals, the failure of AICL to protect TI's intellectual property and a change of control, bankruptcy, liquidation or dissolution of AICL. See "Business -- Competition." 18 20 DEPENDENCE ON RAW MATERIALS SUPPLIERS AND SUBCONTRACTORS The Company obtains the direct materials for the packaging and test services of its factories and for the packaging and test services provided by AICL to fill the Company's orders directly from vendors. To maintain competitive manufacturing operations, the Company must obtain from its vendors, in a timely manner, sufficient quantities of acceptable materials at expected prices. The Company sources most of its raw materials, including critical materials such as lead frames and laminate substrates, from a limited group of suppliers. The Company purchases all of its materials on a purchase order basis and has no long-term contracts with any of its suppliers. From time to time, vendors have extended lead times or limited the supply of required materials to the Company because of vendor capacity constraints and, consequently, the Company has experienced difficulty in obtaining acceptable raw materials on a timely basis. In addition, from time to time, the Company may reject materials that do not meet its specifications, resulting in declines in output or yield. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to obtain sufficient quantities of raw materials and other supplies of an acceptable quality. The Company's business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected if its ability to obtain sufficient quantities of raw materials and other supplies in a timely manner were substantially diminished or if there were significant increases in the costs of raw materials that the Company could not pass on to its customers. See "Business -- Facilities and Manufacturing." INABILITY TO OBTAIN PACKAGING AND TEST EQUIPMENT IN A TIMELY FASHION In connection with its future expansion plans, the Company and AICL expect to purchase a significant amount of new packaging and test equipment. From time to time, increased demand for some of this equipment causes lead times to extend beyond those normally met by the equipment vendors. The unavailability of such equipment or the failure of such equipment, or other equipment acquired by the Company or AICL, to operate in accordance with the Company's or AICL's specifications or requirements, or delays in the delivery of such equipment could delay implementation of the Company's or AICL's expansion plans and impair the ability of the Company to meet customer orders or otherwise have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, results of operations and financial condition. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business -- Facilities and Manufacturing." MANAGEMENT OF GROWTH The Company has experienced and may continue to experience growth in the scope and complexity of its operations and in the number of its employees. For example, the Company is expanding its scope of operations to include wafer fabrication services and is hiring new personnel in connection with such expansion. This growth is expected to continue to strain the Company's managerial, financial, manufacturing and other resources. In addition, although the Company believes its current controls are adequate, in order to manage its growth, the Company must continue to implement additional operating and financial controls and hire and train additional personnel. Although the Company has been successful in hiring and properly training sufficient numbers of qualified personnel and in effectively managing its growth in the past, there can be no assurance that the Company will be able to do so in the future, and its failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, any failure to improve the Company's operational, financial and management systems could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "-- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business -- Employees." COMPETITION The independent semiconductor packaging and test industry is very competitive, being comprised of approximately 50 companies with about 15 of those companies having sales of $100 million per year or more. The Company faces substantial competition from established packaging companies primarily located in Asia, such as Advanced Semiconductor Engineering, Inc. (Taiwan), ASE Test Limited (Taiwan and Malaysia), 19 21 ASAT, Ltd. (Hong Kong), Hana Microelectronics Public Co. Ltd. (Hong Kong and Thailand), Astra International (Indonesia), Carsem Bhd. (Malaysia), ChipPAC Incorporated (Korea), Siliconware Precision Industries Co., Ltd. (Taiwan), and Shinko Electric Industries Co., Ltd. (Japan). Each of these companies has significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research and development operations, marketing and other capabilities, and have been operating for some time. Such companies have also established relationships with many large semiconductor companies which are current or potential customers of the Company. The principal elements of competition in the independent semiconductor packaging market include time to market, breadth of package offering, technical competence, design services, quality, production yields, responsiveness and customer service and price. On a larger scale, the Company also competes with the internal manufacturing capabilities of many of its largest customers. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to compete successfully in the future against existing or potential competitors or that the Company's operating results will not be adversely affected by increased price competition. The independent wafer fabrication business is also highly competitive. The Company expects its wafer fabrication services to compete primarily with independent wafer foundries such as Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing Ltd., Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company Ltd. and United Microelectronics Corporation, as well as with integrated device manufacturers such as LG Semicon Co., Ltd., Hitachi, Ltd., Toshiba Corp. and Winbond Electronics Corporation, which provide foundry services for other semiconductor companies. Each of these companies has significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research and development operations, marketing and other capabilities and have been operating for some time. Many of these companies have also established relationships with many large semiconductor companies which are current or potential customers of the Company. The principal elements of competition in the wafer foundry market include technology, delivery cycle times, price, product performance, quality, production yield, responsiveness and flexibility, reliability and the ability to design and incorporate product improvements. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to compete successfully in the future against such companies. See "Business -- Competition." DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL AND AVAILABILITY OF SKILLED WORKFORCE The Company's success depends to a significant extent upon the continued service of its key senior management and its technical personnel, each of whom would be difficult to replace. Competition for qualified employees is intense, and the loss of the services of any of its existing key personnel without adequate replacement, or the inability to attract, retain and motivate qualified new personnel could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, in connection with its expansion plans, the Company and AICL will be required to increase the number of qualified engineers and other employees at their respective facilities in the Philippines and Korea. Competition for such employees in the Philippines and Korea is intense and the inability to attract new qualified personnel or to retain such personnel could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations and financial condition. See "Management." ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS The semiconductor packaging process involves a significant amount of chemicals and gases which are subject to extensive governmental regulations. For example, liquid waste is produced at the stage at which silicon wafers are diced into chips with the aid of diamond saws and cooled with running water. In addition, excess materials on leads and moldings are removed from packaged semiconductors in the trim and form process. The Company has installed equipment to collect certain solvents used in connection with its manufacturing process and has contracted with independent waste disposal companies to remove such hazardous material. Federal, state and local regulations in the United States, as well as environmental regulations in Korea and the Philippines, impose various controls on the storage, handling, discharge and disposal of chemicals used in the Company's and AICL's manufacturing process and on the facilities occupied by the Company and AICL. The Company believes that its activities, as well as those of AICL, conform to present environmental and land use regulations applicable to their respective operations and current facilities. Increasing public 20 22 attention has, however, been focused on the environmental impact of semiconductor manufacturing operations and the risk to neighbors of chemical releases from such operations. There can be no assurance that applicable land use and environmental regulations will not in the future impose the need for additional capital equipment or other process requirements upon the Company or AICL or restrict the Company's or AICL's ability to expand their respective operations. The adoption of new ordinances or similar measures or any failure by the Company or AICL to comply with applicable environmental and land use regulations or to restrict the discharge of hazardous substances could subject the Company or AICL to future liability or cause their respective manufacturing operations to be curtailed or suspended. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY The Company currently holds 24 United States patents, five of which are jointly held with AICL, related to various IC packaging technologies, in addition to other pending patents. These patents will expire at various dates from 2012 through 2016. With respect to development work undertaken jointly with AICL, the Company and AICL share intellectual property rights under the terms of the Supply Agreements between the Company and AICL. Such Supply Agreements also provide for the cross-licensing of intellectual property rights between the Company and AICL. In addition, the Company enters into agreements with other developers of packaging technology to license or otherwise obtain certain process or package technologies. The Company expects to continue to file patent applications when appropriate to protect its proprietary technologies; however, the Company believes that its continued success depends primarily on factors such as the technological skills and innovation of its personnel rather than on its patents. The process of seeking patent protection can be expensive and time consuming. There can be no assurance that patents will be issued from pending or future applications or that, if patents are issued, they will not be challenged, invalidated or circumvented, or that rights granted thereunder will provide meaningful protection or other commercial advantage to the Company. Moreover, there can be no assurance that any patent rights will be upheld in the future or that the Company will be able to preserve any of its other intellectual property rights. Although the Company is not currently a party to any material litigation, the semiconductor industry is characterized by frequent claims regarding patent and other intellectual property rights. As is typical in the semiconductor industry, the Company may receive communications from third parties asserting patents on certain of the Company's technologies. In the event any third party were to make a valid claim against the Company or AICL, the Company or AICL could be required to discontinue the use of certain processes or cease the manufacture, use, import and sale of infringing products, to pay substantial damages and to develop non-infringing technologies or to acquire licenses to the alleged infringed technology. The Company's business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected by such developments. Litigation, which could result in substantial cost to and diversion of resources of the Company, may also be necessary to enforce patents or other intellectual property rights of the Company or to defend the Company against claimed infringement of the rights of others. The failure to obtain necessary licenses or the occurrence of litigation relating to patent infringement or other intellectual property matters could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, AICL has obtained intellectual property for wafer manufacturing primarily from TI. The licenses granted to AICL by TI under the TI Technology Agreements are very limited. Although TI has granted to AICL a license under TI's trade secret rights to use TI's technology in connection with AICL's provision of wafer fabrication services, TI has not granted AICL a license under its patents, copyrights and mask works to manufacture semiconductors for third parties. Although TI has agreed that TI will not assert a claim for patent, copyright or mask work right infringement against AICL or the Company in connection with AICL's manufacture of semiconductor products for third parties, TI has reserved the right to bring such infringement claims against AICL's or the Company's customers with respect to semiconductor products purchased from AICL or the Company. As a result, AICL's and the Company's customers could be subject to patent litigation by TI and others, and AICL and the Company could in turn be subject to litigation by such customers and others, in connection with the sale of wafers produced by AICL. Any such litigation could materially and adversely affect AICL's ability to continue to manufacture wafers and AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. 21 23 NO PRIOR MARKET; LIQUIDITY; STOCK PRICE VOLATILITY Prior to the Initial Public Offering, there had been no public market for the Common Stock. Although the Underwriters for the Initial Public Offering have advised the Company that they intended to make a market in the Common Stock, they are not obligated to do so and may discontinue such market-making at any time without notice. There can be no assurance that an active public market for the Common Stock will be sustained after the Initial Public Offering or that the market price of the Common Stock will not decline. The trading price of the Common Stock could be subject to wide fluctuations in response to quarter-to-quarter variations in operating results, announcements of technological innovations or new products by the Company or its competitors, general conditions in the semiconductor industry, changes in earnings estimates or recommendations by analysts, or other events or factors. In addition, the public stock markets have experienced extreme price and trading volume volatility in recent months. This volatility has significantly affected the market prices of securities of many high technology companies for reasons frequently unrelated to the operating performance of the specific companies. These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the market price of the Common Stock. BENEFITS OF THE INITIAL PUBLIC OFFERING TO EXISTING STOCKHOLDERS; CONTINUED CONTROL BY EXISTING STOCKHOLDERS Immediately after the closing of the Initial Public Offering, based upon shares outstanding as of the date hereof, James Kim and members of his family beneficially owned in the aggregate 77,610,000 shares of Common Stock, which shares represented all of the outstanding Common Stock not offered in the Initial Public Offering and approximately 65.8% of the total number of shares of Common Stock outstanding following the Initial Public Offering. The Initial Public Offering created a public market for the resale of shares held by these existing stockholders. Such stockholders, acting together, will be able to effectively control substantially all matters requiring approval by the stockholders of the Company. Such matters could include the election of a majority of the members of the Board of Directors, proxy contests, mergers involving the Company, tender offers, open market purchase programs or other purchases of Common Stock that could give stockholders of the Company the opportunity to realize a premium over the then prevailing market price for their shares of Common Stock. In addition, such continued control could also have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of the Company, may discourage bids for the Common Stock at a premium over the market price and may adversely affect the market price of the Common Stock. See "Principal Stockholders." ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS OF DELAWARE LAW AND CERTAIN CHARTER PROVISIONS The Company's Board of Directors has the authority to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock $.001 par value ("Preferred Stock") and to determine the price, rights, preferences and privileges of those shares without any further vote or action by the Company's stockholders. The rights of the holders of Common Stock will be subject to, and may be adversely affected by, the rights of the holders of any Preferred Stock that may be issued in the future. While the Company has no present intention to issue shares of Preferred Stock, such issuance, while providing desirable flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions and other corporate purposes, could have the effect of making it more difficult for a third party to acquire a majority of the outstanding voting stock of the Company. In addition, the Company is subject to the anti-takeover provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, which prohibits the Company from engaging in a "business combination" with an "interested stockholder" for a period of three years after the date of the transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder, unless the business combination is approved in a prescribed manner. The application of Section 203 could have the effect of delaying or preventing a change of control of the Company. The Company's Certificate of Incorporation (the "Certificate of Incorporation") does not permit cumulative voting. This provision, and other provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, the Company's bylaws (the "Bylaws") and Delaware corporate law, may have the effect of deterring hostile takeovers or delaying or preventing changes in control or management of the Company, including transactions in which stockholders might otherwise receive a premium for their shares over then current market prices. 22 24 SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE Sales of substantial amounts of Common Stock into the public market could adversely affect the prevailing market price of the Common Stock. In addition to the up to 7,000,000 shares of Common Stock that may be offered hereby from time to time, there were an additional 40,250,000 shares of Common Stock which were sold to the public in the Initial Public Offering, and there will be 15,333,333 shares issuable upon conversion of the Convertible Notes, all of which shares are freely tradeable. Excluding the shares described above, there are approximately 70,610,000 additional shares of Common Stock outstanding, all of which are "restricted" shares (the "Restricted Shares") under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"). Beginning April 29, 1999, all such Restricted Shares will first become eligible for sale in the public market pursuant to Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act, subject to certain volume and other resale restrictions pursuant to Rule 144. See "Shares Eligible for Future Sale." 23 25 REORGANIZATION In March 1970, Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI") was incorporated in Pennsylvania to design semiconductor packages and provide semiconductor packaging services through a supply relationship with AICL. Since that time, Mr. James Kim (the founder of AEI) and members of his family have acquired a majority interest in a number of other companies which support or engage in various aspects of the semiconductor packaging and test business (the "Amkor Companies"). Prior to the reorganization described below, the Amkor Companies consisted of: - AEI and its subsidiaries Amkor Receivables Corp., which purchases the Company's accounts receivable under an accounts receivable financing arrangement, and Amkor Wafer Fabrication Services SARL, which provides various technical support for CIL's wafer fabrication services customers in Europe and Asia; - T.L. Limited ("TLL") and its subsidiary C.I.L. Limited ("CIL"), which markets the Company's services to semiconductor companies in Europe and Asia; - Amkor/Anam EuroServices S.A.R.L. ("AAES"), which provides various technical and support services for CIL's packaging and test customers; - Amkor/Anam Advanced Packaging, Inc. ("AAAP"), Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. ("AAP") and AAP's subsidiary Automated MicroElectronics Inc. ("AMI"), each of which provides manufacturing services; and - AK Industries, Inc. ("AKI") and its subsidiary, Amkor-Anam, Inc., which provides raw material purchasing and inventory management services. All of the Amkor Companies were substantially wholly owned beneficially by Mr. and Mrs. Kim or entities beneficially owned by members of Mr. James Kim's immediate family (the "Founding Stockholders"), except for 40% of AAP owned by AICL and one-third of AEI and all of AKI which were owned by certain trusts established for the benefit of other members of Mr. Kim's family (the "Kim Family Trusts"). The Company (Amkor Technology, Inc.) was formed in September 1997 to consolidate the ownership of the Amkor Companies. Prior to the reorganization described below, Amkor Technology, Inc. conducted no business and held no assets or liabilities. Prior to the Initial Public Offering, the following transactions were effected to consolidate the operations of the Amkor Companies under the Company, (such transactions are referred to collectively as the "Reorganization"): - AEI was merged into Amkor Technology, Inc. - Amkor International Holdings ("AIH"), a newly formed Cayman Islands holding company, became a wholly-owned subsidiary of Amkor Technology, Inc. holding the following entities: - First Amkor Cayman Islands, Ltd., a newly formed Cayman Islands holding company, and its subsidiaries AAAP, AAP and AMI; - TLL and its subsidiary CIL; and - AAES. - In addition, the Company acquired all of the stock of AKI from the Kim Family Trusts for $3 million. Except for the acquisition of AKI which has been accounted for as a purchase transaction, the accounting for the Reorganization is similar to the accounting for a pooling of interests as it represents an exchange of equity interests among companies under common control. All of the Amkor Companies are wholly owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company (except for AAP, which is 40% owned by AICL). An aggregate of 82,610,000 shares of Common Stock were issued by the Company in connection with the Reorganization. The relative number of shares of Common Stock issued by the Company in connection with each of the transactions comprising the Reorganization was based upon relative amounts of stockholders' equity of each of the Amkor Companies as of December 31, 1997. Accordingly, the Company issued an aggregate of 14,620,140 shares of Common Stock in connection with the merger of AEI into Amkor Technology, Inc., two-thirds of 24 26 which (9,746,760 shares) were received by Mr. and Mrs. Kim and one-third of which (4,873,380 shares) were received by the Kim Family Trusts. The Company then issued an aggregate of 67,989,851 shares of Common Stock, representing approximately 82% of its shares immediately after the Reorganization, in exchange for all of the outstanding shares of AIH and its subsidiaries. Of such shares, 27,528,234 shares and 36,376,617 shares were gifted to Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts, respectively, such that Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts owned 45.1% and 49.9%, respectively, of the Common Stock outstanding after the Reorganization. Following the Reorganization, the Founding Stockholders beneficially owned a majority of the outstanding shares of Common Stock. Following the Initial Public Offering, the Founding Stockholders and the Kim Family Trusts beneficially owned 77,610,000 shares of Common Stock, representing approximately 65.8% of the outstanding shares of Common Stock. See "Certain Transactions" and "Principal Stockholders." The Company has entered into an agreement with AICL pursuant to which the Company will purchase, immediately following the Initial Public Offering, AICL's 40% interest in AAP for approximately $34 million. See "Prospectus Summary -- The Initial Public Offering." TERMINATION OF S CORPORATION STATUS AND DISTRIBUTIONS Prior to the consummation of the Reorganization, AEI had elected to be treated for U.S. federal and certain state tax purposes as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. As a result, AEI did not recognize federal corporate income taxes. Instead, up until the termination of AEI's S Corporation status on April 28, 1998 (the "Termination Date"), Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts had been obligated to pay U.S. federal and certain state income taxes on their allocable portion of the income of AEI. The Company, Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts have entered into tax indemnification agreements providing that the Company will be indemnified by such stockholders, with respect to their proportionate share of any U.S. federal or state corporate income taxes attributable to the failure of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period or in any jurisdiction for which S Corporation status was claimed through the Termination Date. The tax indemnification agreements also provide that under certain circumstances the Company will indemnify Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts if such stockholders are required to pay additional taxes or other amounts attributable to taxable years on or before the Termination Date as to which AEI filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation. AEI has made various distributions to such stockholders which have enabled them to pay their income taxes on their allocable portions of the income of AEI. Such distributions totaled approximately $19.8 million, $13.0 million and $5.0 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. No amounts were distributed during the three months ended March 31, 1998. The Company declared additional distributions to such stockholders prior to the consummation of the Reorganization in an amount equal to AEI's amd Amkor Technology, Inc.'s cumulative net income in all periods prior to the Termination Date less the aggregate amount of distributions previously made to such stockholders. These final distributions are intended to provide such stockholders with the balance of AEI's and Amkor Technology, Inc.'s net income for which they have already recognized taxable income. Through March 31, 1998, the amount of such undistributed net income was $35.7 million. Subsequent to March 31, 1998, aggregate distributions of $33.1 million were made to such stockholders. See Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 25 27 RELATIONSHIP WITH AICL AICL is a Korean company engaged primarily in providing semiconductor packaging and test services to the Company, which in turn sells such services to its customers. AICL also currently markets its services directly in Korea. In addition, AICL manufactures and sells electric wiring devices and watches. AICL operates four semiconductor packaging and test facilities in Korea, and has recently qualified a new deep submicron CMOS wafer foundry in Korea which is currently capable of producing 15,000 8" wafers per month. In March 1998, AICL changed its name to Anam Semiconductor, Inc. AICL was founded in 1956 by Mr. H. S. Kim, who currently serves as the honorary Chairman and a Representative Director of AICL. AICL is a member of the Anam Group, consisting principally of companies in Korea in the electronics industries. The businesses of AICL and the other companies in the Anam Group are influenced to a significant degree by the family of H. S. Kim, which, together with the Company, collectively owned approximately 40.7% of the outstanding common stock of AICL as of December 31, 1997. A significant portion of the shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or for other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. James Kim, the founder of the Company and currently its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, is the eldest son of H. S. Kim. Since January 1992, in addition to his other responsibilities, James Kim has been serving as acting Chairman of the Anam Group and a director of AICL. Mr. In-Kil Hwang, the President and a Representative Director of AICL, is the brother-in-law of James Kim. In addition, four other members of Mr. Kim's family are on the 13 member Board of Directors of AICL. After the Initial Public Offering, James Kim and members of his family beneficially owned approximately 65.8% of the outstanding Common Stock of the Company, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise significant control over the Company. See "Risk Factors -- Benefits of the Initial Public Offering to Existing Stockholders; Continued Control by Existing Stockholders" and "Principal Stockholders." The businesses of the Company and AICL have been interdependent for many years. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998 were derived from services sold by the Company. The Company expects the proportion of its revenues derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL and the proportion of AICL's revenues from services sold by the Company to increase as the Company begins selling the wafer fabrication output of AICL's new wafer foundry and with the Company's assumption from AICL in January 1998 of substantially all of the marketing rights for the Japanese market. In the event the ability of AICL to supply the Company were disrupted for any reason, the Company's facilities in the Philippines would be able to fill only a small portion of the resulting shortfall in capacity. In addition, there are currently no significant third party suppliers of packaging and test services from which the Company could fill its orders. As a result, the Company's business, financial condition and operating results will continue to be significantly dependent on the ability of AICL to effectively provide contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely basis. The Company expects that the businesses of the Company and AICL will continue to remain highly interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship, family ties between their respective shareholders and management, financial relationships, coordination of product and operation plans, joint research and development activities and shared intellectual property rights. The termination of the Company's relationship with AICL for any reason, or any material adverse change in AICL's business resulting from underutilization of its capacity, the level of its debt and its guarantees of affiliate debt, labor disruptions, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates, changes in governmental policies, economic or political conditions in Korea or any other change, could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company has recently entered into the Supply Agreements with AICL. Under the Supply Agreements, AICL has granted to the Company a first right to substantially all of the packaging and test services of AICL and the exclusive right to all of the wafer output of its new wafer foundry. The Company expects to continue to purchase substantially all of AICL's packaging and test services, and to purchase all of AICL's wafer output, under the Supply Agreements. Under the Supply Agreements, pricing arrangements relating to packaging and test services provided by AICL to the Company are subject to quarterly review and adjustment, 26 28 and such arrangements relating to the wafer output provided by AICL to the Company are subject to annual review and adjustment, in each case on the basis of factors such as changes in the semiconductor market, forecasted demand, product mix and capacity utilization and fluctuations in exchange rates, as well as the mutual long-term strategic interests of the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that any new pricing arrangements resulting from such review and adjustment will be favorable to the Company. Pursuant to long-standing arrangements between AICL and the Company's operating subsidiaries, sales from AICL to the Company will continue to be made through AUSA, a wholly-owned financing subsidiary of AICL. Under the Supply Agreements, the Company will continue to reimburse AUSA for the financing costs incurred by it in connection with trade financing provided to the Company. The Supply Agreements also provide that Amkor-Anam, Inc., a subsidiary of the Company, will continue to provide raw material procurement and related services to AICL on a fee basis. The Supply Agreements have a five-year term, and may be terminated by any party thereto upon five years' written notice at any time after the expiration of such initial five-year term. There can be no assurance that AICL will not terminate either Supply Agreement upon the expiration of such initial term or that if it does terminate a Supply Agreement, that the Company will be able to obtain a new agreement with AICL on terms that are favorable to the Company or at all. AICL's ability to continue to provide services to the Company will depend on AICL's financial condition and performance. AICL currently has a significant amount of debt relative to its equity, which debt the Company expects will continue to increase in the foreseeable future. The Company is advised that AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 1997. These consolidated financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP, which differs significantly from U.S. GAAP. U.S. GAAP financial statements are not available. The independent auditors' report regarding AICL, included elsewhere in this Prospectus, includes an explanatory paragraph regarding change in accounting principles, the impact of the Korean economic situation on AICL and its ability to continue as a going concern. 27 29 The following is a summary of 1996 and 1997 consolidated financial information pertaining to AICL prepared in accordance with Korean GAAP which differs from U.S. GAAP. See Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements.
1996 1997 ----------- -------------- (IN MILLIONS) INCOME STATEMENT DATA: Sales................................................. W 1,338,718 W 1,786,457 Cost of sales......................................... 1,096,117 1,507,271 ----------- ----------- Gross profit.......................................... 242,601 279,186 Selling and administrative expenses................... 77,754 103,158 ----------- ----------- Operating income...................................... 164,847 176,028 Non-operating income: Interest and dividend income....................... 38,569 47,592 Foreign exchange gains............................. 10,420 122,507 Other.............................................. 9,268 11,196 ----------- ----------- 58,257 181,295 ----------- ----------- Non-operating expenses: Interest expenses.................................. 138,657 160,658 Amortization of deferred charges................... 2,861 33,891 Foreign exchange losses............................ 39,792 339,204 Loss from forward contract......................... -- 94,644 Other.............................................. 9,962 20,639 ----------- ----------- 191,272 649,036 ----------- ----------- Ordinary income (loss)................................ 31,832 (291,713) Extraordinary gains................................... 447 774 Extraordinary losses.................................. 11,072 1,812 ----------- ----------- Net income (loss) before income taxes................. 21,207 (292,751) Income taxes.......................................... 17,363 7,922 ----------- ----------- Net income (loss) after income taxes.................. 3,844 (300,673) Minority interests in losses (earnings) of consolidated subsidiaries, net..................... (8,569) 1,206 Amortization of consolidation adjustments, net........ (5,326) (3,009) Equity in earnings (losses) of unconsolidated equity-method subsidiaries and investees, net...... 666 (46,253) ----------- ----------- Net loss.............................................. W (9,385) W (348,729) =========== ===========
28 30
1996 1997 ----------- -------------- (IN MILLIONS) SUMMARY BALANCE SHEET DATA: Cash and bank deposits................................ W 324,139 W 215,024 Accounts and notes receivable, net.................... 170,724 189,522 Inventories........................................... 214,494 260,302 Other current assets.................................. 145,302 241,965 ----------- ----------- Total current assets............................... 854,659 906,813 ----------- ----------- Property, plant and equipment, net.................... 994,931 2,159,466 Investments........................................... 83,715 121,880 Long-term accounts receivable......................... 198,251 203,739 Long-term loans....................................... 747 258,322 Other long-term assets................................ 92,985 285,810 ----------- ----------- Total long-term assets............................. 1,370,629 3,029,217 ----------- ----------- Total assets.................................. W2,225,288 W3,936,030 =========== =========== Short-term borrowings................................. 1,050,405 1,720,916 Current maturities of long-term debt.................. 85,252 120,913 Other current liabilities............................. 190,989 282,653 ----------- ----------- Total current liabilities.......................... 1,326,646 2,124,482 ----------- ----------- Long-term debt, net of current maturities............. 475,045 736,784 Long-term capital lease obligations................... 106,068 861,813 Other long-term liabilities........................... 67,672 111,017 ----------- ----------- Total long-term liabilities................... 648,785 1,709,614 ----------- ----------- Total liabilities............................. 1,975,431 3,834,096 ----------- ----------- Minority interests.................................... 21,600 25,160 Stockholders' equity.................................. 228,257 76,774 ----------- ----------- Total liabilities and stockholders' equity.... W2,225,288 W3,936,030 =========== ===========
A significant amount of the current and long-term liabilities of AICL are denominated in U.S. dollars and other foreign currencies. At December 31, 1997, the amount of U.S. dollar and other foreign currency denominated short-term borrowings, current maturities of long-term debt, long-term debt (net of current maturities) and long-term capital lease obligations were W1,222 billion, W59 billion, W159 billion and W834 billion, respectively. Due in part to the significant depreciation of the won (for example, from a Market Average Exchange Rate of W884 to $1.00 on December 31, 1996 to W1,415 to $1.00 on December 31, 1997 and W1,418 to $1.00 on May 14, 1998) resulting from the recent economic crisis in Korea, AICL's liabilities in won terms and its leverage calculated in won have significantly increased in 1997. The effect of this depreciation on AICL, however, has been mitigated by the fact that substantial amounts of AICL's revenues are denominated in U.S. dollars. The increase in AICL's liabilities was also attributable in part to additional financing obtained in connection with the constitution of its new wafer foundry. See "-- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The recent economic crisis in Korea has also led to sharply higher domestic interest rates in Korea and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding maturing debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing financial difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending, particularly to highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and provisions for non-performing assets. These developments will result in higher interest rates on loans to AICL and have otherwise made it more difficult for AICL to obtain new financing. Therefore, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to refinance its existing loans or obtain new loans, or continue to make required interest and principal payments on such loans or otherwise comply with the terms of its loan agreements. Any inability of AICL to obtain financing or generate cash flow from operations sufficient to fund its capital expenditure, debt service and repayment and other working capital and liquidity requirements could have a material adverse effect on AICL's ability to 29 31 continue to provide services and otherwise fulfill its obligations to the Company. See "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated With Leverage" and " -- Dependence On International Operations and Sales; Concentration of Operations in the Philippines and Korea." As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries were contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of AICL's non-consolidated subsidiaries and affiliates in the Anam Group in the aggregate amount of approximately W857 billion. As of such date, AICL had provided guarantees for all of AUSA's debt of $319 million, the Non-Compliant Loans of $176 million and the Company's obligations under a receivables sales arrangement. The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs through financing arrangements obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company, based on guarantees provided by AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. Further, a deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. In addition, as an overseas subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their financing needs through alternative arrangements. Although the Company believes that alternative financing arrangements will be available in the future, there can be no assurance that the Company or AICL will be able to obtain alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. In addition, if any relevant subsidiaries or affiliates of AICL, certain of which may have greater exposure to domestic Korean economic conditions than AICL, were to fail to make interest or principal payments or otherwise default under their debt obligations guaranteed by AICL, AICL could be required under its guarantees to repay such debt, which event could have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations. Historically, AICL has undertaken capacity expansion programs and other capital expenditures primarily on the basis of forecasts of the Company and business plans prepared jointly with the Company. The Supply Agreements generally provide for continued capital investment by AICL based on the Company's forecasts and operational plans prepared jointly by the Company and AICL reflecting such forecasts. However, as a result of the recent deterioration of the Korean economy, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to fund future capacity expansions and other capital investments required to supply the Company with necessary packaging and test services and wafer output on a timely and cost-efficient basis. The Company and AICL have historically cooperated on the development of new package designs and packaging and testing processes and technologies. The Supply Agreements generally provide for continued cooperation between the Company and AICL in research and development, as well as the cross-licensing of intellectual property rights between the Company and AICL. If the Company's relationship with AICL were terminated for any reason, the Company's research and development capabilities and intellectual property position could be materially and adversely affected. The Company will continue to be controlled to a significant degree by James Kim and members of his family for the foreseeable future, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise significant influence over the management of AICL and its affiliates. In addition, the Company and AICL will continue to have certain contractual and other business relationships, including under the Supply Agreements, and may engage in transactions from time to time that are material to the Company. Although any such material agreements and transactions would require approval of the Company's Board of Directors, such transactions generally will not require any additional approval by a separate committee comprised of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors and conflicts of interest may arise in certain circumstances. There can be no assurance that such conflicts will not from time to time be resolved against the interests of the Company. The Company currently has four directors, two of whom are disinterested. Under Delaware corporate law, each director owes a duty of loyalty and care to the Company, which if breached can result in personal liability for the directors. In addition, the Company may agree to certain changes in its contractual 30 32 and other business relationships with AICL, including pricing, manufacturing allocation, capacity utilization and capacity expansion, among others, which in the judgment of the Company's management will result in reduced short-term profitability for the Company in favor of potential long-term benefits to the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that the Company's business, financial condition or results of operations will not be adversely affected by any such decision. USE OF PROCEEDS This Prospectus relates to the shares of Common Stock which Salomon Smith Barney may, subject to certain limitations, from time to time, borrow from Mr. and Mrs. Kim to settle short sales of Common Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Salomon Smith Barney to settle such short sales) entered into by Salomon Smith Barney to hedge any long position in the Convertible Notes resulting from its market-making activities. See "Plan of Distribution." The Company will not receive any proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock to which this Prospectus relates. DIVIDEND POLICY The Company currently anticipates that all future earnings will be retained for use in the Company's business and that the Company will not pay any cash dividends on its Common Stock in the foreseeable future. The payment of any future dividends will be at the discretion of the Company's Board of Directors and will depend upon, among other things, future earnings, operations, capital requirements, the general financial condition of the Company and general business conditions. As an S Corporation, AEI made substantial cash distributions to its stockholders to pay income taxes on their allocable portions of AEI's net income. The Company plans to make additional distributions to such stockholders prior to the Termination Date. See "Reorganization." 31 33 CAPITALIZATION The following table sets forth as of March 31, 1998 (i) the actual capitalization of the Company derived from its unaudited Combined Financial Statements after giving effect to the Reorganization, (ii) the pro forma capitalization of the Company reflecting the termination of AEI's S Corporation status which occurred in connection with the Reorganization, and (iii) the pro forma capitalization of the Company as adjusted principally to reflect the sale by the Company, pursuant to the Initial Public Offering, of 40,250,000 shares of Common Stock at a price to the public of $11.00 per share and $207,000,000 of the Convertible Notes, and the receipt and application by the Company of the net proceeds to it therefrom (after deducting the underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses), as well as debt repayments by the Company after March 31, 1998 and prior to the Initial Public Offering. The capitalization information set forth in the table below is qualified by the more detailed Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto included elsewhere in this Prospectus and should be read in conjunction with such Combined Financial Statements and the Notes thereto.
MARCH 31, 1998 ------------------------------------------ PRO FORMA ACTUAL PRO FORMA(1) AS ADJUSTED(2) -------- ------------ -------------- (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (IN THOUSANDS) Short term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt.............................. $120,173 $120,173 $ 54,126 Long-term debt: 5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2003..................................... -- -- 207,000 Due to AUSA (non-current)(3)................ 88,280 88,280 -- Other long-term debt........................ 197,859 197,859 36,756 -------- -------- -------- Total long-term debt..................... 286,139 286,139 243,756 -------- -------- -------- Stockholders' equity: Common Stock, $.001 par value; 500,000,000 shares authorized; 82,610,000 shares issued and outstanding, actual and pro forma; 117,860,000 shares issued and outstanding, pro forma as adjusted(4).... 46 46 80 Additional paid-in capital.................. 20,871 20,871 382,121 Retained earnings........................... 79,433 45,233 42,234 -------- -------- -------- Total stockholders' equity............... 100,350 66,150 424,435 -------- -------- -------- Total capitalization................ $386,489 $352,289 $668,191 ======== ======== ========
- --------------- (1) Pro forma balance sheet data reflects (i) the termination of AEI's S Corporation status which resulted in the recording of a deferred tax asset of $1.5 million and (ii) a distribution by the Company of undistributed earnings of AEI through March 31, 1998 of $35.7 million to stockholders of AEI prior to the Reorganization. The amount actually distributed by the Company to such stockholders of AEI will reflect the amount of undistributed net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor Technology, Inc. following March 31, 1998 and prior to the Reorganization. See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status and Distributions" and Notes 1, 16 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. (2) As adjusted to give effect to the application of the net proceeds to the Company of the Initial Public Offering, including the purchase from AICL of its 40% interest in AAP for approximately $34 million and the related elimination of minority interest and recording of goodwill. The acquisition of the minority interest will result in additional amortization of approximately $2.5 million per year. Also reflects repayments made after March 31, 1998 and prior to the Initial Public Offering of $2.5 million of amounts due to AUSA (non-current) and the purchase of AK Industries, Inc. for $3 million. See "Prospectus 32 34 Summary -- The Initial Public Offering," "Reorganization" and Notes 1, 6 and 16 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. (3) See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources." (4) Excludes 3,145,900 shares of Common Stock issuable upon exercise of options granted immediately prior to the Initial Public Offering under the Company's 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees and 1998 Director Option Plan. Also excludes an aggregate of 15,333,333 shares reserved for issuance upon conversion of the Convertible Notes and an additional 3,404,100 shares reserved for issuance under the Company's 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees, 1998 Director Option Plan and 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. See "Management" and "Description of Capital Stock" and Notes 1 and 16 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 33 35 SELECTED COMBINED FINANCIAL DATA The selected combined financial data presented below for, and as of the end of, each of the years in the five-year period ended December 31, 1997 and for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1998 are derived from the combined financial statements of Amkor. The combined financial statements as of December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1997 have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public accountants, and their report thereon, together with such combined financial statements, are included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected combined financial data presented below as of and for the year ended December 31, 1994 are derived from audited financial statements which are not presented herein. The selected combined financial data presented below as of and for the year ended December 31, 1993 and for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1998 are derived from unaudited combined financial statements. In the opinion of management, the unaudited combined financial statements have been prepared on the same basis as the audited combined financial statements and contain all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of the Company's results of operations for such periods and financial condition at such dates. The selected combined financial data set forth below is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read in conjunction with, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto.
THREE MONTHS YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, ENDED MARCH 31, --------------------------------------------------------------- ------------------- 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1997 1998 ----------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AND RATIO DATA) INCOME STATEMENT DATA: Net revenues............................ $ 442,101 $ 572,918 $ 932,382 $ 1,171,001 $ 1,455,761 $313,019 $371,733 Cost of revenues........................ 371,323 514,648 783,335 1,022,078 1,242,669 287,449 310,056 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Gross profit...................... 70,778 58,270 149,047 148,923 213,092 25,570 61,677 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative... 42,649 41,337 55,459 66,625 103,726 20,608 28,715 Research and development.............. 1,755 3,090 8,733 10,930 8,525 1,485 2,057 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Total operating expenses.......... 44,404 44,427 64,192 77,555 112,251 22,093 30,772 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Operating income........................ 26,374 13,843 84,855 71,368 100,841 3,477 30,905 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Other (income) expense: Interest expense, net................. 5,116 5,752 9,797 22,245 32,241 8,049 9,522 Foreign currency (gain) loss.......... 2,809 (4,865) 1,512 2,961 (835) (1,490) 2,747 Other (income) expense, net........... (1,725) (877) 6,523 3,150 8,429 1,606 4,089 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Total other expense............... 6,200 10 17,832 28,356 39,835 8,165 16,358 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest.............................. 20,174 13,833 67,023 43,012 61,006 (4,688) 14,547 Provision for income taxes.............. 2,445 2,977 6,384 7,876 7,078 (1,497) 5,050 Equity in income (loss) of AICL......... 1,776 1,762 2,808 (1,266) (17,291) -- -- Minority interest....................... 2,269 1,044 1,515 948 (6,644) 1,638 685 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Net income.............................. $ 17,236 $ 11,574 $ 61,932 $ 32,922 $ 43,281 $ (4,829) $ 8,812 ========= ========= ========= =========== =========== ======== ======== PRO FORMA DATA (UNAUDITED): Historical income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest..................... $ 20,174 $ 13,833 $ 67,023 $ 43,012 $ 61,006 $ (4,688) $ 14,547 Pro forma provision for income taxes(1).............................. 5,345 3,177 16,784 10,776 10,691 62 4,222 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Pro forma income before equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest(1)........................... 14,829 10,656 50,239 32,236 50,315 (4,750) 10,325 Historical equity in income (loss) of AICL.................................. 1,776 1,762 2,808 (1,266) (17,291) -- -- Historical minority interest............ 2,269 1,044 1,515 948 (6,644) 1,638 685 --------- --------- --------- ----------- ----------- -------- -------- Pro forma net income (1)................ $ 14,336 $ 11,374 $ 51,532 $ 30,022 $ 39,668 $ (6,388) $ 9,640 ========= ========= ========= =========== =========== ======== ======== Basic and diluted pro forma net income per common share(1)................... $ .17 $ .14 $ .62 $ .36 $ .48 $ (.08) $ .12 ========= ========= ========= =========== =========== ======== ======== Shares used in computing pro forma net income per common share............... 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 ========= ========= ========= =========== =========== ======== ======== OTHER DATA: EBITDA(2)............................... $ 37,437 $ 34,197 $ 103,434 $ 123,082 $ 175,111 $ 22,983 $ 51,208 ========= ========= ========= =========== =========== ======== ======== Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(3): Actual................................ 3.7x 2.0x 4.6x 2.4x 2.5x 0.5x 2.4x Supplemental pro forma................ 3.8x
34 36 - --------------- (1) Prior to the Reorganization, AEI, a predecessor of the Company, elected to be taxed as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. Accordingly, AEI did not recognize any provision for federal income tax expense during the periods presented. The pro forma provision for income taxes reflects the additional U.S. federal income taxes which would have been recorded if AEI had not been an S Corporation during these periods. See "Reorganization" and Note 1 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. (2) EBITDA is defined as earnings before interest income, interest expense, taxes on income, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is presented here to provide additional information about the Company's ability to meet its future debt service, capital expenditure, and working capital requirements and should not be construed as a substitute for or a better indicator of results of operations or liquidity than net income or cash flow from operating activities computed in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. (3) For purposes of computing the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of income before income taxes less undistributed earnings in less than 50%-owned subsidiaries, plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of interest expense incurred and one-third of rental expense which amount is deemed by the Company to be representative of the interest factor of rental payments under operating leases. The supplemental pro forma ratio of earnings to fixed charges reflects the effect on the ratio of earnings to fixed charges as if the Initial Public Offering had been completed and the net proceeds to the Company applied as described in "Prospectus Summary -- The Initial Public Offering" at the beginning of the period presented.
DECEMBER 31, MARCH 31, 1998 ------------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------------------- 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 ACTUAL PRO FORMA(1) AS ADJUSTED(2) ----------- -------- -------- -------- -------- ----------- ------------ -------------- (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) (IN THOUSANDS) BALANCE SHEET DATA: Cash and cash equivalents........... $ 8,929 $114,930 $ 91,151 $ 49,664 $ 90,917 $ 41,989 $ 6,289 $213,816 Working capital (deficit)............. (13,073) 134,798 111,192 36,785 (38,219) (75,626) (111,326) 162,248 Total assets............ 191,754 426,522 626,379 804,864 855,592 786,888 752,688 992,575 Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt........ 76,051 52,526 85,120 191,813 167,317 120,173 120,173 54,126 5 3/4% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2003.................. -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 207,000 Due to AUSA (non- current).............. 18,823 211,693 219,037 234,894 149,776 88,280 88,280 -- Other long-term debt.... 29,917 62,215 107,385 167,444 196,934 197,859 197,859 36,756 Stockholders' equity.... 8,070 9,617 45,289 45,812 90,875 100,350 66,150 424,435
- --------------- (1) Pro forma balance sheet data reflects (i) the termination of AEI's S Corporation status which resulted in the recording of a deferred tax asset of $1.5 million and (ii) a distribution by the Company of undistributed earnings of AEI through March 31, 1998 of $35.7 million to stockholders of AEI prior to the Reorganization. The amount actually distributed by the Company to such stockholders of AEI will reflect the amount of undistributed net income (loss) recognized by AEI and Amkor Technology, Inc. following March 31, 1998 and prior to the Reorganization. See "Reorganization -- Termination of S Corporation Status and Distributions" and Notes 1, 16 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. (2) As adjusted to give effect to the application of the net proceeds to the Company of the Initial Public Offering, including the purchase from AICL of its 40% interest in AAP for approximately $34 million and the related elimination of minority interest and recording of goodwill. The acquisition of the minority interest will result in additional amortization of approximately $2.5 million per year. Also reflects repayments made after March 31, 1998 and prior to the Initial Public Offering of $2.5 million of amounts due to AUSA (non-current) and the purchase of AK Industries, Inc. for $3 million. See "Prospectus Summary -- The Initial Public Offering," "Reorganization" and Notes 1, 6 and 16 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 35 37 MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS The following discussion contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the federal securities laws, including statements regarding the anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the Company's anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's expected capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future operating performance and other statements that are not historical facts. Because such statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including those set forth in the following discussion as well as in "Risk Factors" and "Business." The following discussion provides information and analysis of the Company's results of operations from 1995 through 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998 and its liquidity and capital resources and should be read in conjunction with the Combined Financial Statements and Notes thereto and the selected combined financial data included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The operating results for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results for any subsequent period. OVERVIEW Background. The Company is the world's largest independent provider of semiconductor packaging and test services. The Company believes that it is also one of the leading developers of advanced semiconductor packaging and test technology in the industry. The Company offers a complete and integrated set of packaging and test services including IC package design, leadframe and substrate design, IC package assembly, final testing, burn-in, reliability testing, and thermal and electrical characterization. The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services. The Company provides packaging and test services through its three factories in the Philippines (P1, P2 and P3) as well as the four factories of AICL in Korea, and wafer fabrication services through AICL's new wafer foundry, pursuant to the Supply Agreements between the Company and AICL. As of December 31, 1997, the Company had in excess of 150 customers, including many of the largest semiconductor companies in the world. The Company was formed in September 1997 to consolidate the operations of the Amkor Companies, including AEI which was incorporated in 1970. These companies were under common management and in the same business prior to the Company's formation. As a result of the Reorganization, the financial statements included in this Prospectus are presented on a combined basis. See "Reorganization" and "Certain Transactions" and Notes 1 and 16 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Prior to the Reorganization, AEI elected to be taxed as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. Accordingly, AEI did not recognize any provision for federal income tax expense during the periods presented in the Combined Financial Statements. The Combined Financial Statements include a pro forma provision for income taxes which reflects the U.S. federal income taxes which would have been recorded by the Company if AEI had not been an S Corporation during these periods. See Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. General. From 1995 to 1997, the Company's revenues increased from approximately $932.4 million to $1.456 billion. This increase occurred primarily as a result of increases in unit volumes, together with the shift in the Company's product mix from traditional leadframe products to advanced leadframe and laminate products, which were offset in part by decreasing average selling prices. See "Business -- Products." In order to meet customer demand, the Company has invested significant resources to expand its capacity in the Philippines. In 1996 and the first six months of 1997, the Company incurred and expensed $15.5 million and $16.6 million, respectively, of pre-operating and start-up costs and initial operating losses in connection with its newest factory, P3, in the Philippines. This facility operated at substantially less than full capacity during these periods while customers were completing qualification procedures for BGA packages to be produced at the facility. The Company significantly increased utilization of P3 during the last six months of 1997 and expects to operate the facility with positive gross margins during 1998. See "Risk Factors -- Expansion of Manufacturing Capacity; Profitability Affected by Capacity Utilization Rates" and "Business -- Facilities and Manufacturing." The Company's results of operations are generally affected by the capital-intensive nature of its business. In 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, the Company invested $123.6 million, 36 38 $185.1 million, $179.0 million and $33.7 million, respectively, in property, plant and equipment. Increases or decreases in capacity utilization rates can have a significant effect on gross margins since the unit cost of packaging and test services generally decrease as fixed charges, such as depreciation expense for the equipment, are allocated over a larger number of units produced. In addition, the Company's gross margin is significantly affected by fluctuations in service charges paid to AICL pursuant to the Supply Agreements. Pricing arrangements relating to packaging and test services provided by AICL to the Company are subject to quarterly review and adjustment, and pricing arrangements relating to wafer fabrication services provided by AICL are subject to annual review and adjustment, in each case on the basis of factors such as changes in the semiconductor market, forecasted demand, product mix and capacity utilization and fluctuations in exchange rates, as well as the mutual long-term strategic interest of the Company and AICL. The Company's results of operations are also affected by declines over time in the average selling prices for particular products. At times in the past the Company has been able to offset, at least in part, the effect of such decline on its margins by successfully developing and marketing new products with higher margins, such as advanced leadframe and laminate products, and by taking advantage of economies of scale and higher productivity resulting from volume production. However, there can be no assurance that the Company will be successful at offsetting any such declines in the future. See "Risk Factors -- Expansion of Manufacturing Capacity; Profitability Affected by Capacity Utilization Rates" and "-- Competition." Due to the concentration of market share in the semiconductor industry, the Company has been largely dependent upon a small group of customers for a substantial portion of its business. In 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, 34.1%, 39.2%, 40.1%, and 34.9%, respectively, of the Company's net revenues were derived from sales to the Company's top five customers, with 13.3%, 23.5%, 23.4% and 19.2%, respectively, derived from sales to Intel. See "Risk Factors -- Customer Concentration; Absence of Backlog." Relationship with AICL. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998 were derived from services sold by the Company. Historically, AICL has directly sold packaging and test services in Japan and Korea. The Company assumed substantially all of the marketing rights for services in Japan in January 1998. Also, the Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry which is capable of producing up to 15,000 8" wafers per month. See "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business." The Company expects the proportion of its net revenues derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL and the percentage of AICL's revenues from services sold by the Company to increase as the Company begins selling the wafer fabrication output of AICL's new wafer foundry and with the Company's assumption from AICL of substantially all of the marketing rights for Japan. The Company has a first right to substantially all of the packaging and test service capacity of AICL and the exclusive right to all of the wafer output of AICL's new wafer foundry. The Supply Agreements between the Company and AICL generally provide, among other things, for periodic price reviews and adjustments and coordination of research and development efforts regarding package design and packaging and testing processes and technologies. The Supply Agreements have a five year initial term and thereafter may be terminated upon five years' notice. There can be no assurance that AICL will not terminate either Supply Agreement upon the expiration of such initial term, or that if it does terminate a Supply Agreement, that the Company will be able to enter into a new agreement with AICL on terms favorable to the Company or at all. See "Relationship with AICL." The Company expects that the businesses of the Company and AICL will continue to remain highly interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship, overlaps and family ties between their respective shareholders and management, financial relationships, coordination of product and operation plans, joint research and development activities and shared intellectual property rights. As a result, the Company's business, financial condition and operating results will continue to be significantly dependent on AICL, including without limitation AICL's ability to effectively provide the contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely basis as well as AICL's financial condition and results of operations. The Company will continue to be controlled to a significant degree by James Kim and members of his family, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will also continue to exercise significant influence over the management of AICL and 37 39 its affiliates. In addition, the Company and AICL will continue to have certain contractual and other business relationships and may engage in transactions from time to time that are material to the Company. Although any such material agreements and transactions would require approval of the Company's Board of Directors, such transactions will generally not require any additional approval by a separate committee comprised of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors and conflicts of interest may arise in certain circumstances. There can be no assurance that such conflicts will not from time to time be resolved against the interests of the Company. The Company currently has four directors, two of whom are disinterested. Under Delaware corporate law, each director owes a duty of loyalty and care to the Company, which if breached can result in personal liability for the directors. In addition, the Company may agree to certain changes in its contractual and other business relationships with AICL, including pricing, manufacturing allocation, capacity utilization and capacity expansion, among others, which in the judgment of the Company's management will result in reduced short-term profitability for the Company in favor of potential long-term benefits to the Company and AICL. There can be no assurance that the Company's business, financial condition or results of operations will not be adversely affected by any such decision. See "-- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Relationship with AICL; Potential Conflicts of Interest." RESULTS OF OPERATIONS The following table sets forth certain operating data as a percentage of net revenues for the periods indicated:
THREE MONTHS ENDED YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, MARCH 31, ------------------------ ------------- 1995 1996 1997 1997 1998 ------ ------ ------ ----- ----- Net revenues........................... 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% Cost of revenues....................... 84.0 87.3 85.4 91.8 83.4 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Gross profit......................... 16.0 12.7 14.6 8.2 16.6 Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative.................... 6.0 5.7 7.1 6.6 7.7 Research and development............. 0.9 0.9 0.6 0.5 0.6 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Total operating expenses.......... 6.9 6.6 7.7 7.1 8.3 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Operating income....................... 9.1 6.1 6.9 1.1 8.3 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Other (income) expense: Interest expense, net................ 1.0 1.9 2.2 2.6 2.6 Foreign currency (gain) loss......... 0.2 0.2 (0.1) (.05) 0.7 Other expense, net................... 0.7 0.3 0.6 0.5 1.1 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Total other expense............... 1.9 2.4 2.7 2.6 4.4 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest............................. 7.2 3.7 4.2 (1.5) 3.9 Provision for income taxes............. 0.7 0.7 0.5 (0.5) 1.3 Equity in income (loss) of AICL........ 0.3 (0.1) (1.2) 0.0 0.0 Minority interest...................... 0.2 0.1 (0.5) 0.5 0.2 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Net income............................. 6.6 2.8 3.0 (1.5) 2.4 Pro forma adjustment for income taxes................................ 1.1 0.2 0.3 0.5 (0.2) ----- ----- ----- ----- Pro forma net income................... 5.5% 2.6% 2.7% (2.0)% 2.6% ===== ===== ===== ===== =====
THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1998 COMPARED TO THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1997 Net Revenues. The Company's net revenues consist of fees for the packaging and testing of ICs which are consigned by customers to the Company's or AICL's factories. The Company's net revenues increased 18.8% to $371.7 million for the three months ended March 31, 1998, compared to $313.0 million for the same period in 1997. The growth in revenues was attributable to a significant growth in unit volumes of semiconductors packaged and tested by the Company. The proportion of the Company's revenues derived from traditional leadframe products declined in the first quarter of 1998 as compared to the corresponding quarter in 1997 while revenues from laminate products and advanced leadframe products increased during this 38 40 period. Because the Company's advanced leadframe and laminate products tend to have higher average selling prices than traditional leadframe products, this change in the mix of products sold during the first three months of 1998 helped to offset generally declining average selling prices for the Company's products on an overall basis. Revenues from the Company's wafer fabrication services accounted for less than 1% of total revenues during the first quarter of 1998. Gross Profit. Gross profit increased to $61.7 million, or 16.6% of net revenues, for the three months ended March 31, 1998 from $25.6 million, or 8.2% of net revenues, in the three months ended March 31, 1997 due primarily to improved gross profit at the Company's newest factory, P3, compared with negative gross profit for this factory in the three months ended March 31, 1997 while P3 was in its start-up phase. In addition, increased unit volumes during the three months ended March 31, 1998 allowed the Company to improve volume related margins. As a result of the devaluation of the Philippine peso, the Company also was able to reduce certain peso denominated costs of its Philippine factory operations, resulting in lower costs and improved gross margins. The new Supply Agreement with AICL with respect to packaging and test services, which went into effect on January 1, 1998, also provided the Company with improved gross margins on products purchased from AICL during the three months ended March 31, 1998 compared with the three months ended March 31, 1997. Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased to $28.7 million, or 7.7% of net revenues, during the three months ended March 31, 1998, compared to $20.6 million or 6.6% of revenues during the three months ended March 31, 1997, as a result of growth in the number of employees in the Company's marketing and sales support groups of approximately 21% during 1997. Such growth has resulted in an overall increase in personnel-related costs including salaries, benefits and payroll taxes. The Company also incurred higher costs for office rental, depreciation and other occupancy-related expenses in the first three months of 1998 as compared to the first three months of 1997. The Company does not expect the level of growth to continue in 1998. Research and Development Expenses. Research and development expenses increased 38.5% to $2.1 million during the three months ended March 31, 1998, compared to $1.5 million for the same period in 1997. The increase was primarily due to increased expenditures by the Company resulting from increased headcount and corresponding payroll-related costs. Other (Income) Expense. Other expense increased during the three months ended March 31, 1998 to $16.4 million from $8.2 million for the same period in 1997. The increase of $8.2 million was primarily attributable to an increase in foreign exchange losses, a $1.5 million increase in interest expense and a $2.5 million increase in other expenses, net. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulted from the change in the value of the Philippine peso relative to the U.S. dollar which during the three months ended March 31, 1998 resulted in a $2.7 million dollar foreign exchange loss consisting of realized and unrealized losses. By comparison, changes in the value of the Philippine peso relative to the U.S. dollar resulted in a foreign currency gain of $1.5 million for the three months ended March 31, 1997. Interest expense, net for the first quarter of 1998 increased $1.5 million compared to the corresponding period in 1997 due to increased debt balances over the prior year. Other expense, net increased by $2.5 million for the three months ended March 31, 1998 compared to the same period in 1997 due primarily to financing costs associated with the accounts receivable sale agreement entered into by the Company in July 1997 as well as one-time bank charges incurred during the three months ended March 31, 1998. Income Taxes. The Company's effective tax rate (after giving effect to the pro forma adjustment for income taxes) for the three months ended March 31, 1998 was 29% as compared to 1.3% for the same period in 1997. The low effective tax rate in 1997 was attributable to losses at the Company's subsidiary which owns P3. The Company's subsidiary that owns P3 operates under a tax holiday from Philippine income taxes until the end of 2002. To the extent P3 is profitable, the Company's effective tax rate related to its Philippine operations during the tax holiday will be less than the Philippine statutory rate of 35%. Equity in Income (Loss) of AICL. Equity in income (loss) of AICL represents the Company's ownership interest in AICL. During the fourth quarter of 1997, the Company wrote this investment down to its realizable value and recorded a $17.3 million loss for 1997 resulting principally from the impairment in value in its investment in AICL. In February 1998, the Company sold its investment in AICL for $13.9 million. See Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 39 41 Minority Interest. Minority interest represents AICL's ownership interest in the consolidated net income of AAP. Accordingly, the Company recorded a minority interest expense in its combined financial statements relating to the minority interest in the net income of AAP. The Company has entered into an agreement with AICL to purchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP and, as a result, the Company will own all of the common stock of AAP. See "Prospectus Summary -- The Initial Public Offering." The acquisition of the minority interest will result in the elimination of the minority interest liability and in additional amortization of approximately $2.5 million per year. YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996 Net Revenues. Net revenues for 1997 increased 24.3% to $1,455.8 million from $1,171.0 million for 1996 primarily due to an increase in unit volumes of semiconductors packaged and tested by the Company, offset in part by declines in average selling prices for many of the Company's leadframe products. In addition, the opening of P3, the Company's newest factory, and K4, AICL's newest factory, in September 1996 enabled the Company to begin to expand sales of BGA packages in 1997. Gross Profit. Gross profit increased 43.1% to $213.1 million in 1997 from $148.9 million in 1996, resulting in a gross margin of 14.6% for 1997 as compared to 12.7% for 1996. Cost of revenues consists principally of packaging and test service charges from AICL, costs of direct material for both the Philippine factories and AICL and labor and other costs at the Philippine factories. Gross margin increased primarily due to improved operating results at P1 and P2 during the second half of 1997, which more than offset initial operating losses and start-up costs incurred in connection with P3 during the first half of 1997. Product mix changes toward more profitable product lines and decreased labor costs from the devaluation of the Philippine peso were the primary factors resulting in improved margins at the P1 and P2 factories. Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased 55.7% to $103.7 million, or 7.1% of net revenues, in 1997 from $66.6 million, or 5.7% of net revenues, in 1996 primarily due to increases in personnel in marketing and support to sustain the Company's growth. The number of employees in the Company's marketing and sales support groups increased during 1997 by approximately 21% over 1996. Such increase resulted in an overall increase in personnel-related costs including salaries, benefits and payroll taxes. The Company also incurred increased costs for office rental, depreciation and other occupancy-related expenses. The Company does not expect this level of growth in employees to continue in 1998. In addition to the increased costs from its marketing and sales support groups, the Company incurred approximately $8.0 million and $3.6 million in general and administrative expenses in connection with its P3 operations and wafer fabrication services group, respectively, during 1997. No similar costs were incurred in 1996 as these groups represented start-up operations in 1997. Research and Development Expenses. Research and development expenses decreased 22.0% to $8.5 million, or 0.6% of net revenues, in 1997, from $10.9 million, or 0.9% of net revenues, in 1996. The decrease in research and development costs principally reflected the termination in late 1996 of the Company's efforts to develop its own laminate substrate manufacturing capability. Other (Income) Expense. Other expense increased 40.5% to $39.8 million in 1997 from $28.4 million in 1996 primarily as a result of increased interest expense and increased other expenses. Interest expense for 1997 increased to $38.6 million from $27.7 million in 1996 as the Company significantly increased its borrowing to finance capacity expansion. See "-- Liquidity and Capital Resources." Interest expense in each of the periods was offset in part by interest income of $6.4 million and $5.5 million, respectively. Other expenses increased primarily due to $2.4 million in costs relating to the Company's trade receivables securitization transactions. See "-- Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 2 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Income Taxes. The Company's effective tax rate (after giving effect to the pro forma adjustment for income taxes) for 1997 was 18% as compared to 25% for 1996. The decrease in the Company's effective tax rate in 1997 compared to 1996 was primarily attributable to income not taxed due to the tax holiday available to the Company's subsidiary which owns P3 and the foreign exchange effects described below. The Company recognized deferred tax benefits for unrealized foreign exchange losses in 1997 which are recognized in the Philippines for tax reporting purposes and relate to unrecognized net foreign exchange losses on U.S. dollar 40 42 denominated monetary assets and liabilities. See Note 10 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. These losses are not recognized for financial reporting purposes as the U.S. dollar is the functional currency. These losses will be realized for Philippine tax reporting purposes upon settlement of the related asset or liability. The benefit derived from unrealized foreign exchange losses was partially offset by an increase in the valuation allowance as the Company concluded that it was more likely than not that their tax benefits could be realized in the Philippines within the three year loss carryforward period. The Company has structured its global operations to take advantage of lower tax rates in certain countries and tax incentives extended to encourage investment. The recorded provisions for income taxes are subject to changes upon examination of the Company's tax returns by tax authorities in the United States, the Philippines and elsewhere. Changes in the mix of income from the Company's foreign subsidiaries, expiration of tax holidays and changes in tax laws and regulations could result in increased effective tax rates for the Company. Equity in Income (Loss) of AICL. In 1997, the Company recognized a loss of $17.3 million resulting principally from the impairment of value in its investment in AICL. In February 1998, the Company disposed of its investment in AICL's common stock. See "Certain Transactions" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Minority Interest. Minority interest represents AICL's ownership interest in the consolidated net income of AAP. During 1997, as a result of a settlement of an intercompany loan, which otherwise had no effect on the combined pretax income of the Company, AAP reported a net loss as a separate entity. Accordingly, the Company recorded a minority interest benefit in its combined financial statements relating to the minority interest in the net loss. YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995 Net Revenues. Net revenues in 1996 increased 25.6% to $1.17 billion from $932.4 million in 1995. The increase was primarily due to an increase in units sold together with an increase in sales of newer products, such as advanced leadframe and laminate packages. This increase in sales of newer products offset declines in average selling prices for many of the Company's other products. Gross Profit. Gross profit in 1996 and 1995 was approximately $149 million representing a decrease in gross margin to 12.7% in 1996 from 16.0% in 1995. The decrease in gross margin was primarily attributable to increases in cost of revenues due to $15.5 million in pre-operating and start-up costs associated with P3, as well as increased packaging and test service charges paid to AICL. Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased 20.1% to $66.6 million, or 5.7% of net revenues, in 1996 from $55.5 million, or 6.0% of net revenues, in 1995 as a result of the addition of personnel and infrastructure to service increases in customer demand. In addition, the Company continued its investments in new information systems in order to enhance operating efficiencies and improve customer service and support. Research and Development Expenses. Research and development expenses increased 25.2% to $10.9 million, or 0.9% of net revenues, in 1996 from $8.7 million, or 0.9% of net revenues, in 1995 as a result of increased staffing and funding for the Company's efforts to develop laminate substrate manufacturing capabilities, prior to termination of such efforts in late 1996. Other (Income) Expense. Other expense increased 59.0% to $28.4 million in 1996 from $17.8 million in 1995 primarily as a result of increases in interest expense, net, offset in part by a decrease in other expense, net. Interest expense, net in 1996 increased to $22.2 million from $9.8 million in 1995 as the Company significantly increased its borrowing to finance capacity expansion. See "-- Liquidity and Capital Resources." As a result of this increase in debt, the Company's interest expense increased to $27.7 million in 1996 from $17.3 million in 1995. Income Taxes. The Company's effective tax rate (after giving effect to the pro forma provision for income taxes) for 1996 and 1995 was 25%. These rates were different from the United States statutory rate primarily due to the impact of lower tax rates, including tax holidays, in certain of the countries in which the Company's subsidiaries are located. See Note 10 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 41 43 QUARTERLY RESULTS The following table sets forth certain unaudited combined financial information, including as a percentage of net revenues, for the eight fiscal quarters ended March 31, 1998. The Company disposed of its investment in AICL common stock in February 1998. Also, the Company has entered into an agreement with AICL pursuant to which the Company will purchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP. After the disposition of the Company's interest in AICL there was no other equity in income (loss) of AICL. Following the Company's acquisition of AICL's interest in AAP, there will be no minority interest related to AAP. Consequently, this information is not presented below. The amounts of equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest have historically varied significantly by quarter depending on the income (loss) of AICL and AAP. See "Reorganization" and Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The Company believes that all necessary adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments, have been included in the amounts stated below to present fairly the selected quarterly information when read in conjunction with the Combined Financial Statements and the Notes thereto included elsewhere herein. The Company's results of operations have varied and may continue to vary significantly from quarter to quarter and are not necessarily indicative of the results of any future period. In addition, in light of the Company's recent growth, the Company believes that period-to-period comparisons should not be relied upon as an indication of future performance.
QUARTER ENDED --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- JUNE 30, SEPT. 30, DEC. 31, MAR. 31, JUNE 30, SEPT. 30, DEC. 31, MAR. 31, 1996 1996 1996 1997 1997 1997 1997 1998 -------- --------- -------- -------- -------- --------- -------- -------- (IN THOUSANDS) Net revenues.......................... $272,262 $285,784 $342,628 $313,019 $350,471 $380,130 $412,141 $371,733 Cost of revenues...................... 231,959 250,898 308,834 287,449 299,093 314,246 341,881 310,056 -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- Gross profit........................ 40,303 34,886 33,794 25,570 51,378 65,884 70,260 61,677 Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative.................... 15,948 16,716 20,209 20,608 26,657 26,829 29,632 28,715 Research and development............ 2,757 3,071 3,002 1,485 2,030 2,236 2,774 2,057 -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- Total operating expenses.......... 18,705 19,787 23,211 22,093 28,687 29,065 32,406 30,772 -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- Operating income...................... 21,598 15,099 10,583 3,477 22,691 36,819 37,854 30,905 Total other expense, net.............. 6,052 9,853 9,135 8,165 9,577 11,242 10,851 16,358 -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest............................ 15,546 5,246 1,448 (4,688) 13,114 25,577 27,003 14,547 Provision for income taxes............ 2,847 961 265 (1,497) 4,186 842 3,547 5,050 -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- -------- Income before equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest....... $ 12,699 $ 4,285 $ 1,183 $ (3,191) $ 8,928 $ 24,735 $ 23,456 $ 9,497 ======== ======== ======== ======== ======== ======== ======== ========
QUARTER ENDED ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- JUNE 30, SEPT. 30, DEC. 31, MAR. 31, JUNE 30, SEPT. 30, 1996 1996 1996 1997 1997 1997 ---------- ---------- ----------- ---------- ---------- ---------- Net revenues.......................... 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% Cost of revenues...................... 85.2 87.8 90.1 91.8 85.3 82.7 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Gross profit........................ 14.8 12.2 9.9 8.2 14.7 17.3 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative.................... 5.9 5.8 5.9 6.6 7.6 7.1 Research and development............ 1.0 1.1 0.9 0.5 0.6 0.5 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Total operating expenses.......... 6.9 6.9 6.8 7.1 8.2 7.6 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Operating income...................... 7.9 5.3 3.1 1.1 6.5 9.7 Total other expense, net.............. 2.2 3.5 2.7 2.6 2.8 3.0 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest............................ 5.7 1.8 0.4 (1.5) 3.7 6.7 Provision for income taxes............ 1.0 0.3 0.1 (0.5) 1.2 0.2 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Income before equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest....... 4.7% 1.5% 0.3% (1.0)% 2.5% 6.5% ===== ===== ===== ===== ===== ===== QUARTER ENDED ------------------------ DEC. 31, MAR. 31, 1997 1998 ----------- ---------- Net revenues.......................... 100.0% 100.0% Cost of revenues...................... 83.0 83.4 ----- ----- Gross profit........................ 17.0 16.6 ----- ----- Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative.................... 7.2 7.7 Research and development............ 0.6 .6 ----- ----- Total operating expenses.......... 7.8 8.3 ----- ----- Operating income...................... 9.2 8.3 Total other expense, net.............. 2.6 4.4 ----- ----- Income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest............................ 6.6 3.9 Provision for income taxes............ 0.9 1.3 ----- ----- Income before equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest....... 5.7% 2.6% ===== =====
42 44 The Company's revenues, gross profit and operating profit are generally lower in the first quarter of the year as compared to the fourth quarter of the preceding year primarily due to the combined effect of holidays in the United States, the Philippines and Korea. Semiconductor companies in the United States generally reduce their production during the holidays at the end of December which results in a significant decrease in orders for packaging and testing services during the first two weeks of January. In addition, the Company typically closes its factories in the Philippines for holidays in January, and AICL closes its factories in Korea for holidays in February. As a result of these factors, the Company's net revenues are significantly reduced during the months of January and February. Beginning in the third quarter of 1996, intense competition in the semiconductor industry worldwide led to decreases in the average selling prices of many of the Company's leadframe packages. These decreases were partially offset by increases in sales of advanced leadframe and laminate packages, which carry higher prices and gross margins. In addition, the Company's cost of revenues as a percentage of revenues increased significantly during the three quarters ended March 31, 1997 primarily as a result of initial operating losses and start-up costs associated with P3. Cost of revenues was also affected in the two quarters ended June 30, 1997, as the Company recognized a $2.2 million write-off for custom laminate raw materials which were purchased to meet customer orders which were subsequently cancelled. The combined effect of these factors was to decrease the levels of profitability in the third and fourth quarters of 1996 and the first quarter of 1997. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased during the second, third and fourth quarters of 1997 primarily due to increased staffing levels at the Company's marketing and sales support groups, as well as at its P3 factory and wafer fabrication services group, which resulted in increased employee-related costs. See "-- Results of Operations -- Year Ended December 31, 1997 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 1996 -- Selling, General and Administrative Expenses." Income tax rates in the third quarter of 1997 were lower compared to prior periods as the Company recognized deferred tax benefits for unrealized foreign exchange losses during the quarter, which are recognized for Philippine tax reporting purposes but are not recognized for financial reporting purposes since the U.S. dollar is the functional currency. Although similar circumstances during the fourth quarter of 1997 resulted in the recognition of additional deferred tax assets, their effect on the overall tax rates were mitigated by a valuation allowance also recorded during the fourth quarter of approximately $22 million. See "-- Results of Operations -- Year End December 31, 1997 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 1996 -- Income Taxes." As the majority of these tax assets relate to fluctuations in the value of the Philippine peso, management is unable to determine the impact to the effective tax rates which may occur as a result of future exchange rate fluctuations. The Company's quarterly operating results may vary significantly due to a variety of factors including, among others, the cyclical nature of both the semiconductor industry and the markets addressed by end-users of semiconductors, the short-term nature of its customers' commitments, timing and volume of orders relative to the Company's production capacity, changes in capacity utilization, evolutions in the life cycles of customers' products, rescheduling and cancellation of large orders, rapid erosion of packaging selling prices, availability of manufacturing capacity, allocation of production capacity between the Company's facilities and AICL's facilities, fluctuations in packaging and test service charges paid to AICL, changes in costs, availability and delivery times of labor, raw materials and components, effectiveness in managing production processes, fluctuations in manufacturing yields, changes in product mix, product obsolescence, timing of expenditures in anticipation of future orders, availability of financing for expansion, changes in interest expense, the ability to develop and implement new technologies, competitive factors, changes in effective tax rates, the loss of key personnel or the shortage of available skilled workers, international political or economic events, currency and interest rate fluctuations, environmental events, and intellectual property transactions and disputes. Unfavorable changes in any of the above factors may adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, the Company increases its level of operating expenses and investment in manufacturing capacity in anticipation of future growth in revenues. To the extent the Company's revenues do not grow as anticipated, the Company's financial condition and operating results may be materially adversely affected. See "Risk Factors -- Fluctuations in Operating Results; Declines in Average Selling Price." 43 45 LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES At March 31, 1998, the Company had cash and cash equivalents of $42.0 million and a working capital deficit of $75.6 million ($6.3 and $111.3 million, respectively, on a pro forma basis, after giving effect to the termination of AEI's S Corporation status and the distribution of undistributed earnings through March 31, 1998). The Company's working capital deficit resulted primarily from the significant amount of its short-term debt, primarily incurred in connection with the expansion of its Philippine operations. The Company used the net proceeds received from the Initial Public Offering primarily to repay an aggregate of approximately $240 million of debt, including the Non-Compliant Loans and $86 million of amounts due to AUSA. In addition, the Company will use such net proceeds to repay $65 million of short-term loans and $8 million of term loans and will use $34 million of such net proceeds to repurchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP. See "Prospectus Summary -- The Initial Public Offering." Following the application of the estimated net proceeds of the Initial Public Offering to the Company together with repayments of debt prior to the Initial Public Offering, the Company will have $54 million of short-term borrowing and current portion of long-term debt, $244 million of long-term debt and no amounts then due to AUSA. In addition, the remaining $213 million of such net proceeds will be available for capital expenditures and working capital. The Company has been investing significant amounts of capital to increase its packaging and test services capacity, including the construction of P3, the addition of capacity in the Company's other Philippine facilities and the construction of a new manufacturing facility in the United States. Advanced packaging processes are being developed at the U.S. facility and full scale operations are expected to begin in 1999. In 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, the Company made capital expenditures of $123.6 million, $185.1 million, $179.0 million and $33.7 million, respectively. Because the Company and AICL have added a significant amount of packaging and test capacity in recent years, the Company intends to decrease its level of capital expenditures in 1998. The Company currently intends to spend approximately $60 million in capital expenditures in 1998, including for the new factory in the U.S. and moderate capacity expansion at the Company's existing facilities in the Philippines to meet expected demand. The Company believes that expenditure levels could increase substantially in 1999 to provide the Company with adequate capacity. The Company believes that its existing cash balances, cash flow from operations, available equipment lease financing, bank borrowings and financing obtained through AUSA will be sufficient to meet its anticipated cash requirements including working capital and capital expenditures, for at least the next 12 months. There can be no assurance, however, that lower than expected revenues, increased expenses, increased costs associated with the purchase or maintenance of capital equipment, decisions to increase planned capacity or other events will not cause the Company to seek more capital, or to seek capital sooner than currently expected. The timing and amount of the Company's actual capital requirements cannot be precisely determined and will depend on a number of factors, including demand for the Company's services, availability of capital equipment, fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates, changes in semiconductor industry conditions and competitive factors. There can be no assurance that such additional financing will be available when needed or, if available, will be available on satisfactory terms. Failure to obtain any such financing could have a material adverse effect on the Company. In addition, if the Company obtains such financing by selling equity securities of the Company, the Company's stockholders may experience significant dilution. The Company historically has met a significant portion of its cash requirements for working capital and capital expenditures from a combination of cash from operating activities, short-term and long-term bank loans and financing obtained for the benefit of the Company by AUSA, a wholly-owned financing subsidiary of AICL, as well as financing from a trade receivables securitization agreement. Cash provided by operating activities in 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998 was $53.3 million, $8.6 million, $250.1 million and $87.0 million, respectively. Cash provided (used) by financing activities was $71.2 million, $148.0 million, $(16.0) million and $(102.5) million for 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, respectively. At March 31, 1998, the Company's debt consisted of $120.2 million of borrowings classified as current liabilities, $197.9 million of long-term debt and capital lease obligations and $88.3 million of amounts due to 44 46 AUSA. As of March 31, 1998, the Company had extended guarantees in respect of bank debt of affiliates in the amount of $5.0 million and in respect of vendor obligations of an affiliate in the amount of $5.7 million, which amount may vary over time. At March 31, 1998, the Company had $172.2 million in borrowing facilities with a number of domestic and foreign banks, of which $23.3 million remained unused. Certain of the agreements with such banks require compliance with certain financial covenants and restrictions, and are collateralized by assets of the Company. These facilities are typically revolving lines of credit and working capital facilities for one-year renewable periods and generally bear interest at rates ranging from 8.5% to 21%. Long-term debt and capital lease obligations outstanding at March 31, 1998 have various expiration dates through April 2004, and accrue interest at rates ranging from 6.7% to 12.5%. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs through financing arrangements obtained by AUSA, AICL's wholly-owned financing subsidiary. A majority of the amount which was due to AUSA represented outstanding amounts under financing obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company, with the balance representing payables to AUSA for packaging and service charges paid to AICL. Based on guarantees provided by AICL, AUSA obtains for the benefit of the Company a continuous series of short-term financing arrangements which generally are less than six months in duration, and typically are less than two months in duration. Because of the short term nature of these loans, the flows of cash to and from AUSA under this arrangement have been significant. At March 31, 1998, the Company had utilized $88.3 million of the approximately $108 million of credit facilities available to the Company through AUSA. These credit facilities are with U.S. branches of a number of banks located in Korea and have interest rates ranging from approximately 10.05% to prime plus 8.5% (17% at March 31, 1998). Because of the recent deterioration of the Korean economy, Korean banks have begun to raise interest rates applicable to their lending. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on International Operations and Sales; Concentration of Operations in the Philippines and Korea -- Korea." As its credit lines have been renewed, AUSA has experienced a significant increase in interest rates, and there can be no assurance that such increases will not continue. The Company reimburses AUSA for certain of the interest charges incurred by AUSA under these credit facilities. As an overseas subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their financing needs through alternative arrangements. Although the Company believes that alternative financing arrangements will be available in the future, there can be no assurance that the Company or AICL will be able to obtain alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all. AUSA has received commitments from its banks indicating that they intend to renew the facilities when they expire through at least April 1, 1999. AUSA has extended similar terms to the Company with respect to amounts due to AUSA by the Company. Accordingly, amounts due to AUSA are classified as non-current liabilities on the Company's balance sheet at March 31, 1998. See Notes 2 and 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. At March 31, 1998, all of AUSA's debt of $318 million, the Non-Compliant Loans of $154 million and the Company's obligations under the Receivables Sale (as defined below) were guaranteed by AICL. AICL currently has a significant amount of debt relative to its equity and is contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of its subsidiaries and affiliates, including AUSA. As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries had guarantees outstanding in respect of debt of its non-consolidated subsidiaries and affiliates in the Anam Group in the aggregate amount of approximately W857 billion, including the guarantees of the Company's loans. As a result of its relationship with AICL, the Company's business, financial condition and operating results are significantly dependent on AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. In addition, a deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. See "-- Overview -- Relationship with AICL," "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Relationship with AICL; Potential Conflicts of Interest" and "Relationship with AICL" In July 1997, the Company entered into a trade receivables securitization agreement with a commercial financial institution. Under the terms of the agreement, the financial institution has committed to purchase, with limited recourse, all right, title and interest in eligible receivables, as defined in the agreement, up to $100 million (the "Receivables Sale"). Funds received pursuant to the agreement reflect a discount of 45 47 LIBOR plus 0.375% from accounts receivable sold. The Company applied approximately $83.4 million of the initial Receivables Sale proceeds together with approximately $17 million of working capital to reduce the Company's indebtedness to AUSA, which amounts were advanced by AUSA to entities controlled by members of James Kim's family. See Note 2 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Prior to the consummation of the Reorganization, AEI was treated for U.S. federal and certain state tax purposes as an S Corporation under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax laws. As a result, AEI did not recognize U.S. federal corporate income taxes. Instead, up until the Termination Date, Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts had been obligated to pay U.S. federal and certain state income taxes on their allocable portion of the income of AEI. The Company, Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts have entered into tax indemnification agreements providing that the Company will be indemnified by such stockholders, with respect to their proportionate share of any U.S. federal or state corporate income taxes attributable to the failure of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period or in any jurisdiction for which S Corporation status was claimed through the Termination Date. The tax indemnification agreements also provide that under certain circumstances the Company will indemnify Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts if such stockholders are required to pay additional taxes or other amounts attributable to taxable years on or before the Termination Date as to which AEI filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation. AEI has made various distributions to Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts which have enabled them to pay their income taxes on their allocable portions of the income of AEI. Such distributions totaled approximately $19.8 million, $13.0 million and $5.0 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. No distributions were made to such stockholders in the first three months of 1998. The Company declared additional distributions to such stockholders immediately prior to the consummation of the Reorganization in an amount equal to AEI's and Amkor Technology, Inc.'s cumulative net income in all periods prior to the Termination Date less the aggregate amount of distributions previously made to such stockholders. These final distributions are intended to provide such stockholders with the balance of AEI's and Amkor Technology, Inc.'s net income for which they have already recognized taxable income. Through March 31, 1998, the amount of such undistributed net income was $35.7 million. Subsequent to March 31, 1998 aggregate distributions of $33.1 million were made to such stockholders. See "Reorganization" and Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION GAINS AND LOSSES The Company's subsidiaries in the Philippines maintain their accounting records in U.S. dollars. This is due to the fact that all sales, the majority of all bank debt and all significant material and fixed asset purchases of such subsidiaries are denominated in U.S. dollars. As a result, the Philippine subsidiaries' exposure to changes in the Philippine peso/U.S. dollar exchange rate relates primarily to certain receivables and advances and other assets offset by payroll, pension and local liabilities. To minimize its foreign exchange risk, the Company selectively hedges its net foreign currency exposure through short-term (generally not more than 30 to 60 days) forward exchange contracts. To date, the Company's hedging activity has been immaterial. 46 48 BUSINESS The following discussion contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the U.S. federal securities laws, including statements regarding the anticipated growth in the market for the Company's products, the Company's anticipated capital expenditures and financing needs, the Company's expected capacity utilization rates, the belief of the Company as to its future operating performance and other statements that are not historical facts. Because such statements include risks and uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those anticipated in such forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors, including those set forth herein, in "Risk Factors" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." Amkor is the world's largest independent provider of semiconductor packaging and test services. The Company believes that it is also one of the leading developers of advanced semiconductor packaging and test technology in the industry. The Company offers a complete and integrated set of packaging and test services including IC package design, leadframe and substrate design, IC package assembly, final testing, burn-in, reliability testing, and thermal and electrical characterization. As of December 31, 1997, the Company had in excess of 150 customers, including many of the largest semiconductor companies in the world. Such customers include, among others, Advanced Micro Devices, Inc., International Business Machines Corp., Intel, Lucent Technologies, Inc., Motorola, Inc., National Semiconductor Corp., Philips Electronics N.V., SGS-THOMSON Microelectronics N.V., Siemens AG and TI. The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry. This foundry is currently capable of producing up to 15,000 8" wafers per month. Through a strategic relationship with TI, the Company and AICL have qualified .25 micron CMOS process technology, and TI has agreed to provide to AICL .18 micron CMOS process technology during 1998. This foundry will primarily manufacture digital signal processors ("DSPs"), application specific integrated circuits ("ASICs") and other logic devices. By leveraging the Company's leading position in semiconductor packaging and test services, the new wafer fabrication services have enabled the Company to become one of the first providers of a fully integrated, turnkey semiconductor fabrication, packaging and test service solution. The Company provides packaging and test services through its three factories in the Philippines as well as the four factories of AICL in Korea pursuant to a Supply Agreement between the Company and AICL, under which AICL provides packaging and test services to the Company. In 1996, 1997 and the first three months of 1998, AICL provided packaging and test services representing approximately 72%, 68% and 67% respectively, of the Company's net revenues. INDUSTRY BACKGROUND Manufacturing Process The production of a semiconductor is a complex process that requires increasingly sophisticated engineering and manufacturing expertise. The production process can be broadly divided into three primary stages: (i) wafer fabrication, (ii) assembly of die into finished devices (referred to as "packaging") and (iii) testing of finished devices and other back-end processes. 47 49 [ORGANIZATIONAL CHART] The wafer fabrication process begins with the generation of a mask that defines the circuit patterns for the transistors and interconnect layers that will be formed on the raw silicon wafer. The transistors and other circuit elements are formed by repeating a series of process steps wherein a photosensitive material is first deposited on the wafer, the material is exposed to light through the mask in a photolithography process, and finally, the unwanted material is etched away, leaving only the desired circuit pattern on the wafer. By stacking up the various patterns, the individual elements of the semiconductor are defined. The final step in the wafer fabrication process is to electrically test each individual chip in a wafer probe process in order to identify the good chip for packaging. The fabricated wafers are then transferred to packaging facilities. Semiconductor packaging serves to protect the chip, facilitate integration into electronic systems, and enable the dissipation of heat from the devices. In the packaging process, the wafer is diced into its individual die which are then separated from the wafer and attached to a substrate via an epoxy adhesive. Leads on the substrate are then connected by extremely fine gold wires to the input/output ("I/O") terminals on the chips through the use of automated machines known as "wire bonders". Each die is then encapsulated in a plastic molding compound, thus forming the package, which then goes through several additional finishing steps to prepare it for testing. Following packaging, each packaged device is then tested utilizing a sophisticated test platform and program which tests the many different operating specifications of the IC, including functionality, voltage, current and timing. The completed devices are either shipped back to the customer or shipped directly to their final destination. Trends Toward Outsourcing Historically, semiconductor companies manufactured semiconductors primarily in their own factories. Independent packagers of semiconductors were used solely to handle the overflow volume requirements of semiconductor companies. Outsourcing of final testing and wafer fabrication was virtually non-existent in the 48 50 early days of the industry. Over the past fifteen years, however, the need for independent semiconductor packaging and test services has grown dramatically for several reasons. First, semiconductor companies are facing ever-increasing demands for miniaturization, higher lead counts and improved thermal and electrical performance in IC packages. As a result of this trend, semiconductor packaging is now viewed as an enabling technology requiring sophisticated expertise and technological innovation. Independent providers of packaging and test services have developed substantial expertise in packaging and test technology and new package innovation. Semiconductor companies, having found it difficult to keep pace using their internal resources, have come to rely increasingly on the independent packaging and test services providers as a key source for new technology development and innovation. Second, semiconductor companies are increasingly seeking to shorten their time to market for new products. Having the right packaging technology and capacity in place is a critical factor in reducing time to market. As packaging solutions are identified for a specific product, semiconductor companies frequently do not have the equipment or expertise to implement such solutions in the volumes required, nor sufficient time to develop these capabilities before introducing a new product into the market. For this reason, semiconductor companies are increasingly leveraging the resources and capabilities of independent packaging and test companies to deliver their new products to market more quickly. Third, the packaging and testing of ICs has evolved into an increasingly complex process that requires substantial investment in specialized equipment and facilities. For example, the investment in facilities and equipment necessary for a processing line capable of packaging 100 million ball grid array ("BGA") packages per year can be as much as $200 million. As a result of the substantial cost of this manufacturing equipment, the equipment must be utilized at a high capacity level for an extended period of time in order to be cost effective. With semiconductor companies facing increasingly shorter product life cycles, faster new product introductions and the need to continuously update or replace packaging equipment to accommodate new products, it has become increasingly difficult for semiconductor companies to sustain such high levels of capacity utilization. Independent providers of packaging and test services, on the other hand, can use existing equipment at high utilization levels over a longer period of time for a broad range of customers, effectively extending the life of the equipment. Fourth, as the cost to build a new wafer fabrication facility has increased to over $1 billion, semiconductor companies have been forced to concentrate their capital resources on core wafer manufacturing activities. As a result, semiconductor companies are increasingly seeking to use independent packaging and test providers who have the ability to invest the capital to develop new packaging and test capacity. The Company believes that as the cost to construct new wafer fabrication facilities continues to increase, semiconductor manufacturers will increasingly seek to outsource packaging and test services. Fifth, there has been a recent growth of "fabless" semiconductor companies whose core competency and focus is entirely on the semiconductor design process. According to industry estimates, sales by fabless semiconductor companies have grown from $3.2 billion in 1993 to $6.8 billion in 1996, representing 3.7% and 4.8%, respectively, of the worldwide market for semiconductors. The significant growth in the number of fabless semiconductor companies has been driven in large part by the ability of such companies to effectively outsource virtually every significant step of the semiconductor manufacturing process. This development has allowed fabless semiconductor companies to introduce new semiconductors very quickly without committing significant amounts of capital and other resources. The Company believes that increases in the number of fabless semiconductor companies will continue to be a significant driver of growth in the independent semiconductor manufacturing industry. These trends, combined with the growth in the number of ICs being produced and sold, are driving increasing demand for independent packaging and test services. According to industry estimates, independent packaging revenues are expected to grow at a compound annual rate of approximately 16% over a period of five years from $5.6 billion in 1997 to $11.6 billion in 2002. Today, nearly all of the world's major semiconductor companies use independent packaging and test service providers for at least a portion, if not all, of their packaging and test needs. 49 51 Many of the same forces that have driven the growth of independent packaging and test have also been driving increasing demand for independent wafer fabrication services. Moreover, because the cost of new wafer fabrication facilities has been rising steadily, many semiconductor companies are seeking to leverage their capital resources by outsourcing some or all of their wafer fabrication needs. This is particularly true for newer, smaller geometry technologies that are necessary for producing the newest, leading edge ICs, because they cannot be produced in many semiconductor companies' existing wafer fabrication facilities. As the demand for ICs with smaller geometries increases, the Company believes semiconductor companies will increasingly utilize independent wafer manufacturers. The Need for Turnkey Solutions The growing demand for independent wafer fabrication, packaging, and test services has generally been served by separate wafer fabrication, packaging or test companies. This creates inefficiencies for semiconductor companies which must manage the delays, complex logistics and uncertainty inherent in utilizing a different service provider for each step of the semiconductor manufacturing process. Only a very few, if any, independent service providers have the capability of providing a combination of wafer fabrication, packaging and test services. THE AMKOR SOLUTION Amkor is the largest independent provider of semiconductor packaging and test services in the world. With its leading edge process technology and package design expertise, the Company is able to provide its customers with a broad range of new packaging solutions that enable faster, smaller and more powerful ICs. Due to its size and industry-leading position, the Company is capable of implementing and utilizing the capital equipment necessary for both new and mature packages, thereby affording its customers an attractive alternative in their capital allocation decisions. In addition, with AICL's new wafer fabrication capabilities, the Company is able to offer a fully integrated, turnkey semiconductor manufacturing solution. STRATEGY Principal elements of the Company's strategy include: Maintain Product Technology Leadership. The Company believes that it is one of the world's leading designers and developers of new semiconductor packaging technology. The Company has designed and developed such leading edge leadframe and laminate products as its PowerQuad(R), SuperBGA(R), fleXBGA(TM) and ChipArray(TM) BGA packages. The Company is focusing additional design and development efforts on new generations of the BGA packaging format and on "flip chip" die attach technologies where the I/O pads on the chip are attached directly to the package's substrate rather than with wire-bonded connections. The Company employs a staff of leading semiconductor packaging technologists and undertakes significant research and development activities in its Chandler, Arizona and Philippines locations, as well as through joint development activities with AICL's development staff in Korea. The Company intends to continue to maintain its leading packaging technology position. Maintain Advanced Manufacturing Capabilities. The Company believes that its tradition of manufacturing excellence has been a key factor in its success in attracting and retaining customers, and it is committed to maintaining that high level of excellence. Key to this effort is the Company's commitment to continuous advancement of its process technology. The Company's development teams work with its customers, suppliers, and others to develop new processing technologies as well as pursue continuous improvements in the Company's existing processing capabilities. These efforts have directly resulted in reduced time to market, increased quality, and lower manufacturing costs. Leverage Scale and Scope of the Company's Packaging and Test Capabilities. The Company believes that its scale of operations and its breadth of product offerings provide it with several competitive advantages. First, the Company believes that its size and position in the industry allow it certain advantages in procuring key materials and manufacturing equipment. Second, the Company is able to capitalize on the substantial economies of scale that result from high utilization rates of its capital equipment, thereby lowering the 50 52 Company's per unit manufacturing costs and facilitating cost-effective solutions for its customers. The Company's scale also allows it to offer an industry-leading breadth of product offerings and to be a single source for many of its customers' packaging requirements. The Company offers over 450 different package formats and sizes with a variety of processing and materials options. The Company added 175 and 139 new packaging options, respectively, in 1996 and 1997. The Company is committed to continued expansion of both its size of operations and its scope of product and service offerings. Establish Industry Packaging Standards. The Company believes that by bringing new package designs to market early, its designs are more likely to become industry standards, which in turn will allow the Company to obtain higher margins than its competitors for such new designs. The Company also seeks to capture substantial market share and to spur the industry-wide adoption of its new packages by investing aggressively in expanding its manufacturing capacity for these packages. As a result, it is one of the leading providers of advanced packaging solutions such as thin package formats and BGA packages. The Company believes these package types will comprise some of the highest growth and more profitable segments of the packaging market in coming years. Enhance Customer and Supplier Relationships. As the world's largest independent provider of semiconductor packaging and test services, the Company has developed long-standing strategic relationships with leading semiconductor and electronics companies, its suppliers, and other developers of new semiconductor technologies. The Company believes that these relationships have allowed it to stay ahead of the constantly advancing demand curve for independent packaging services. The Company has repeatedly developed leading-edge packaging technologies that have met the requirements of newer IC devices and that have been quickly accepted in the marketplace. The Company's alliances with certain of its key equipment and material suppliers have enabled the Company to achieve packaging and manufacturing process innovation and cost reduction. Developing and maintaining these relationships within the industry will continue to be an integral part of the Company's overall strategic direction. Focus on Customer Service and Support. The Company believes that its focus on customer service and support has been crucial in attracting and retaining leading semiconductor companies as its customers. The Company has a firmly established customer-oriented culture. To provide a dedicated customer support infrastructure and to stay abreast of customers' expectations, the Company has strategically established technical and sales teams near major customer facilities and in acknowledged technology centers. In addition, the Company has implemented direct electronic links with its customers to enhance communication and facilitate real-time engineering data and order information flow. Provide an Integrated, Turnkey Solution. The Company seeks to provide a complete turnkey solution comprising wafer fabrication, packaging and test services. The Company recently began providing wafer fabrication services through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry. With the addition of wafer fabrication, the Company is able to provide all stages of IC production for its customers from the fabrication of wafers through the shipment of finished ICs. The Company believes this integration will enable customers to improve the cost and performance of their ICs and achieve faster time to market for both new product introductions and production lead times. 51 53 PRODUCTS Packaging The Company offers a broad range of package formats designed to provide customers with a full array of packaging solutions for both commodity and advanced products. The Company's products are divided into three product families: traditional leadframe, advanced leadframe, and laminate products as shown in the following tables.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- TRADITIONAL LEADFRAME PRODUCTS - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- - ------------------------------------------ PACKAGE TYPE NUMBER OF LEADS APPLICATIONS - ------------------------------------------ --------------- -------------------------------------- PDIP (Plastic Dual In-line Packages) 8-48 General purpose plastic IC package for SPDIP (Shrink DIP) 28-64 consumer electronic products such as games, telephones, TV, audio equipment and computer peripherals. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Hermetic Custom A line of mature, ceramic predominant packages used especially for high-reliability applications (military, space and commercial aviation). - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- PLCC (Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier) 20-84 Used for logic, gate arrays, DAC, processors and chip sets used in larger form-factor items (copiers, printers, scanners, desktop PCs, electronic games and monitors). - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SOIC (Small Outline Integrated Circuit) 8-44 Designed for needs of lower lead devices. End uses include consumer audio/video and entertainment products, pagers, cordless telephones, fax machines, copiers, printers, PC peripherals and automotive parts. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- MQFP (Metric Quad Flat Package) 44-304 Adapted to meet the increasing challenges of advanced processors/controllers, DSPs, ASICs, video-DAC, PC chip sets, gate arrays, logic devices, multimedia and other technologies for consumer, commercial, office, automotive, PC and industrial products. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- PowerQuad(R) 100-304 Higher performance thermally enhanced QFP package. Used for DSPs, programmable logic devices, microprocessors and micro-controllers, high-speed and field programmable gate array logic devices, ASIC and other technologies requiring more thermal performance than offered by standard QFP packages. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- PowerSOP(TM) 8-36 Higher performance thermally enhanced SOIC package. Used for wireless RF telecom devices, automotive, industrial, disk drive, pagers, and other technologies requiring more thermal performance than offered by standard SOIC packages.
================================================================================ 52 54
- ------------------------------------------ ADVANCED LEADFRAME PRODUCTS - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- - ------------------------------------------ PACKAGE TYPE NUMBER OF LEADS APPLICATIONS - ------------------------------------------ --------------- -------------------------------------- TQFP (Thin Quad Flat Package) 32-256 Designed for lightweight, portable electronics requiring broad performance characteristics, including notebook computers, desktop PCs, audio/video and telecommunications products, cordless/RF devices, office equipment, disk drives and communication boards (e.g., Ethernet and ISDN). - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- TSOP (Thin Small Outline Package) 32-48 Primary application is for SRAM, DRAM, FLASH and FSRAM memory devices. End uses include PC cards, PCMCIA form-factor products, cameras (still/video) and notebook computers. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- TSSOP (Thin Shrink Small Outline Package) 8-80 Designed for gate drivers, controllers, logic, analog, memory (SRAM, DRAM, EPROM, E2PROM), comparators and optoelectronics. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SSOP (Shrink Small Outline Package) 8-64 Designed to enable end-products such as pagers, portable audio/video products, disk drives, and wireless applications to be reduced in size and weight. - --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
53 55
- ------------------------------------------ LAMINATE PRODUCTS - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- - ------------------------------------------ PACKAGE TYPE NUMBER OF BALLS APPLICATIONS - ------------------------------------------ --------------- -------------------------------------- PBGA (Plastic Ball Grid Array) 119-544 Semiconductors for end users which require the enhanced performance provided by the integrated design of PBGA, including microprocessors/ controllers, ASICs, gate arrays, memory, DSPs and PC chip sets. Designed for applications where improved portability, form-factor and high-performance are necessary, including wireless products, cellular, GPS, notebook computers, video cameras and disk drives. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SuperBGA(R) 64-600 Designed for high-speed, high-power semiconductors such as ASICs, microprocessors, gate arrays, and DSPs. Applications include wireless products, notebook computers, PDAs, video GUI and CPU/BUS boards. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- fleXBGA(TM) 133-412 Higher performance, lower profile package than PBGA due to size reduction made possible by denser substrate. Ideal for high performance disk drives, cellular phones, pagers, wireless communications, DSPs and micro-controller applications. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- MicroBGA(TM) 8-200 Especially suited for memory devices such as FLASH, SRAM, DRAM and FSRAM technologies, microprocessors/ controllers and high value ASICs requiring a low height, weight and size packaging. End uses include cellular and other telecommunications products, disk drives, notebooks/sub-notebooks, PDAs, wireless and consumer systems and memory boards. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ChipArray(TM) 36-128 Designed for semiconductors such as memory, analog, ASICs and PLDs requiring a smaller package than conventional PBGAs. Applications include cellular and other telecommunications, notebooks/sub- notebooks, PDAs, wireless systems and GPS. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- FlipChip N/A An enabling interconnect technology which can be utilized in advanced IC packages such as PBGA, chip scale and flex circuit solutions to support improved electrical requirements and very high semiconductor density in very small systems.
================================================================================ 54 56 Traditional Leadframe Products. Traditional leadframe products are the most widely recognized package types and are characterized by a chip encapsulated in a plastic mold compound with metal leads surrounding the perimeter. This package type has evolved from packages designed to be plugged into the circuit board by inserting the leads into holes on the circuit board to the more modern surface-mount design, in which the leads are soldered to the surface of the circuit board. Specific package customization and evolutionary improvements are continually being engineered to enable improved electrical performance and multi-chip capability, as well as smaller printed circuit board footprints. The Company offers a wide range of lead counts and body sizes within this product group to satisfy customer die size variations. In addition, the Company offers power versions of the SOP, PLCC, and MQFP package types which are specially designed to handle today's high power ICs that need with enhanced heat dissipation characteristics. Advanced Leadframe Products. The Company's customers are seeking increasingly thinner packages, which has led the Company to develop newer, more advanced leadframe products. The Company's advanced leadframe products are similar in design to its traditional leadframe products. However, the advanced leadframe products generally are thinner and smaller, have more leads, and have advanced thermal and electrical characteristics which are necessary for many of today's more advanced semiconductor applications. The TSOP, TSSOP and SSOP packages are significantly smaller than the Company's traditional SOIC products, while the TQFP package is a smaller version of the MQFP package. The Company also offers power versions of these package types. The Company plans to continue to develop increasingly smaller versions of these products to keep pace with continually shrinking die sizes and increasing demands for miniaturization. Laminate Products. The laminate product family represents the newest and fastest growth area for the Company and consists of products employing the BGA format which utilize a laminate (plastic or tape) substrate rather than a leadframe substrate. BGA technology was first introduced in the industry as a solution to problems associated with the increasingly high lead counts required for advanced semiconductors. As the number of leads surrounding the IC increased, packagers attempted to maintain the size of the package by increasing the proximity of the leads to one another. As a result, however, these high lead count packages experienced significant electrical shorting problems and required the development of increasingly sophisticated and expensive techniques for producing circuit boards to accommodate the density of the leads. The BGA methodology solved this problem by effectively creating leads on the bottom of the package in the form of small bumps or balls. These balls can be evenly distributed across the entire bottom surface of the package, allowing greater distance between the individual leads. The Company's first product in this family was the plastic BGA. The Company has subsequently designed additional BGA type packages which include features that enable low cost, high volume manufacturing methods as well as higher performance packages. These new laminate products include: SuperBGA(R), which includes a copper heat-sink for heat dissipation and is designed for very low profile, high power applications; ChipArray(TM), which allows the package to be as small as 1.5 mm larger than the chip itself; and MicroBGA(TM), which is designed to be approximately the same size as the chip and uses a tape substrate rather than a plastic laminate. The Company is currently designing newer versions of BGA packages to enable further significant reductions in package size. Test and Related Services The Company also provides its customers with semiconductor test services. The Company has the capability to test digital logic, analog and mixed signal products. The combination of the Company's test operations together with AICL's Korean test operations comprises one of the largest independent test operations in the world. Providing test services requires a high level of communication and integration between the Company and its customers. In order to enable semiconductor companies to improve their time to market and to reduce costs, there has been an increasing trend to put packaging and test operations in the same location. The Company has capitalized on this trend by supplying its own testers or by supplementing customer-supplied testers with handlers and other related equipment. Although test services accounted for only 3.5% of the Company's total 1997 revenue and 13% of the total units shipped, the Company expects test services to grow significantly during the next several years as customers seek to reduce the time to market for their products by using contractors with test services at the 55 57 packaging site. In addition to final test services, the Company provides a full range of other related services, such as burn-in test services, "dry pack" services, "tape and reel" packing, and wafer "probing" or "sorting." The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the amount of the Company's net revenues and the percentage of total net revenues by product type:
THREE MONTHS ENDED 1994 1995 1996 1997 MARCH 31, 1998 ---------------- ---------------- ---------------- ---------------- ----------------- REVENUES % REVENUES % REVENUES % REVENUES % REVENUES % -------- ----- -------- ----- -------- ----- -------- ----- -------- ----- (DOLLARS IN MILLIONS) Traditional Leadframe.......... $487 85.1% $699 75.0% $ 792 67.6% $ 801 55.0% $182 48.9% Advanced Leadframe... 53 9.2 157 16.8 220 18.8 312 21.5 85 22.9 Laminate............. 3 0.5 15 1.6 90 7.7 248 17.0 80 21.5 Testing and Other.... 30 5.2 61 6.6 69 5.9 95 6.5 25 6.7 ---- ----- ---- ----- ------ ----- ------ ----- ---- ----- Total............ $573 100.0% $932 100.0% $1,171 100.0% $1,456 100.0% $372 100.0% ==== ===== ==== ===== ====== ===== ====== ===== ==== =====
Wafer Fabrication The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through AICL's new deep submicron CMOS foundry. This foundry is currently capable of producing up to 15,000 8" wafers per month. Through a strategic relationship with TI, the Company and AICL have qualified .25 micron CMOS process technology, and TI has agreed to provide to AICL .18 micron CMOS process technology during 1998. The Company's right to the supply of wafers from the foundry is subject to the TI Manufacturing and Purchasing Agreement, pursuant to which TI has agreed to purchase at least 40% of the capacity of the foundry and under certain circumstances has the right to purchase 70% of the capacity of the foundry. Although the Company has received forecasts from TI which indicate that TI will meet its minimum purchase obligation during the second half of 1998, during the first quarter of 1998 TI's orders were below such minimum purchase commitment and it is uncertain whether TI will meet its purchase obligations in the second quarter due to market conditions and issues encountered by TI in the transition of its products to .18 micron technology. There can be no assurance that TI will place orders representing at least 40% of the capacity of this foundry during this period or in the future. A failure by TI to comply with its minimum purchase obligations or the cancellation of a significant wafer fabrication order by TI or any other customer could have a material adverse effect on AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business" and " -- Intellectual Property." The new foundry's capability is targeted to meet the needs of customers for DSPs, ASICs and other logic devices. As technological capability and the needs for CMOS designs in this area change, the Company anticipates the need to add embedded memory and special analog functionality to its core CMOS technology. The Company plans to continue to focus its semiconductor technology development efforts to serve the needs of the high performance digital logic market. With the addition of the wafer fabrication capability, the Company is able to offer fully integrated turnkey semiconductor manufacturing services to its customers. This complete turnkey solution will enable the Company to work with its customers' IC designers to optimize the integration of IC design with wafer fabrication, package design, and packaging and test processes. The Company believes this integration will enable customers to improve the cost and performance of their ICs and achieve faster time to market in terms of both new product introductions and production lead times. 56 58 CUSTOMERS The Company currently has more than 150 customers, including many of the largest semiconductor companies in the world. Set forth below is a list of the Company's top 50 customers in 1997: Actel Corporation Integrated Circuit Systems, Inc. Plessey Semiconductors Altera Corporation Integrated Device Technology, Inc. Philips Electronics N.V. Adaptec, Inc. Intel Corporation Robert Bosch GmbH Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Lattice Semiconductor Rockwell Corp. Alcatel Mietec Corporation S3 Incorporated American Micro Systems, Inc. Level One Communications, Inc. SGS-THOMSON Analog Devices, Inc. LSI Logic Corporation Microelectronics N.V. Atmel Corporation Lucent Technologies Inc. Siemens AG Cirrus Logic Macronix International Co., Ltd. SMC Corporation Cypress Semiconductor Corp. Matra Harris Semiconductors Silicon Storage Dallas Semiconductor Maxim Integrated Circuits Technology, Inc. Delco Electronics Corporation Microchip Technology Inc. Symbios Logic Digital Equipment Corp. Microlinear TEMIC Semiconductors Harris Corporation Motorola, Inc. Texas Instruments Hewlett-Packard Company National Semiconductor Incorporated International Business Machines Corporation VLSI Technology, Inc. Corporation NeoMagic Corporation VTC Inc. IC Works Inc. Northern Telecom Waferscale Integration, Inc. Xilinx, Inc.
The Company's five largest customers collectively accounted for approximately 34.1%, 39.2%, 40.1% and 34.9% of the Company's total revenues in 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, respectively. The Company anticipates that this customer concentration will continue at least for the foreseeable future. See "Risk Factors -- Customer Concentration; Absence of Backlog." MARKETING AND SALES The Company sells to and supports its customers through an international network of offices located in close proximity to its largest customers and concentration of customers, including offices in the United States (Austin, Texas; Boise, Idaho; Chandler, Arizona; Dallas, Texas; Santa Clara, California and West Chester, Pennsylvania), France, Singapore, Taiwan, and the Philippines. A substantial majority of the Company's sales have historically been derived from U.S.-based customers. See Note 15 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The Company assigns each of its customers a sales and customer support team consisting of an account manager, a technical program manager, and one or more customer support representatives. The largest multinational customers are typically supported from multiple offices. The Company's worldwide force of account managers, customer service representatives and technical product managers exceeds 200 personnel. In addition, an extended staff of product management, process and reliability engineering, marketing and advertising, information systems, and factory personnel supports the direct account teams. Together, these direct and extended teams deliver an array of services to the Company's customers including providing information and expert advice on packaging solutions and trends, managing the start-up of specific packaging and test programs, providing a continuous flow of information to the customers regarding products and programs in process, and researching and helping to resolve technical and logistical issues. FACILITIES AND MANUFACTURING Facilities The Company provides packaging and test services through its factories in the Philippines as well as its test facility in the U.S. A new packaging factory is currently being equipped at the Company's Chandler, Arizona site with expected start-up in 1999. In addition, the Company provides packaging and test services 57 59 through AICL's four factories in Korea, which provide such services to the Company pursuant to a Supply Agreement. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, AICL provided packaging and test services which accounted for approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues. In addition to providing world-class manufacturing services, these factories provide purchasing, engineering, and customer service support. The Company recently began offering wafer fabrication services through AICL's new state-of-the-art .25 micron wafer foundry in Korea pursuant to a Supply Agreement. The size, location, and manufacturing services provided by each of the Company's and AICL's primary facilities is set forth in the table below. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Relationship With AICL; Potential Conflicts of Interest," "-- Expansion of Manufacturing Capacity; Profitability Affected by Capacity Utilization Rates," "-- Risks Associated with New Wafer Fabrication Business" and "-- Inability to Obtain Packaging and Test Equipment in a Timely Fashion."
APPROXIMATE PLANT SIZE FACILITY LOCATION (SQUARE FEET) MANUFACTURING SERVICES -------- -------- ------------- ---------------------- Company Facilities P1 Muntilupa, Philippines 579,000 Packaging and test services; packaging and process development P2 Muntilupa, Philippines 115,000 Packaging services P3 Province of Laguna, Philippines 249,000 Packaging and test services AATS Santa Clara, California 3,000 Final testing services; test program development; central shipping and logistics A1 (1999) Chandler, Arizona 106,000 Packaging services for laminate products; package and process development AICL Facilities K1 Seoul, Korea 646,000 Packaging services, package and process development K2 Buchon, Korea 264,000 Packaging services K3 Bupyung, Korea 404,000 Packaging and test services K4 Kwangju, Korea 597,000 Packaging services Wafer Foundry Buchon, Korea 480,000 Wafer fabrication services
The Company's operational headquarters is located in Chandler, Arizona while its administrative headquarters is located in West Chester, Pennsylvania. In addition to an executive staff, the Chandler, Arizona campus houses sales and customer service for the southwest region, product management, a technical design center, planning, marketing and research and development. The West Chester location houses finance and accounting, legal, personnel administration, information systems, and serves as a satellite sales office for the Company's eastern sales region. Raw Materials and Equipment The Company's packaging operations depend upon obtaining adequate supplies of raw materials on a timely basis. The principal raw materials used in the Company's packaging process are leadframes or laminate substrates, along with gold wire and molding compound. The Company purchases raw materials based on the stated demand requirements of its customers and its customers are generally responsible for any unused materials that result from an overstatement of demand. The Company works closely with its primary raw material suppliers to insure the availability and timeliness of raw material supplies. In addition, the Company negotiates worldwide pricing agreements with its major suppliers to take advantage of the scale of its operations. The Company is not dependent on any one supplier for a substantial portion of its raw material requirements. The Company's packaging operations and expansion plans also depend on obtaining adequate supplies of manufacturing equipment on a timely basis. To that end, the Company works closely with its major equipment suppliers to insure that equipment deliveries are on time and the equipment meets the Company's stringent performance specifications. In addition, an affiliate of AICL manufactures semiconductor packaging equip- 58 60 ment exclusively for the Company and AICL at locations in close proximity to the Company's and AICL's packaging facilities in the Philippines and Korea, respectively. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Raw Materials Suppliers and Subcontractors." Total Quality Management The Company believes that total quality management is a vital component of its manufacturing strategy. To that end, the Company has established a comprehensive Quality Operating System designed to promote continuous improvement and maximize manufacturing yields at high volume production while maintaining the highest quality standards. Each of the Company's and AICL's factories is ISO9002 and QS-9000 certified. ISO9002 is a worldwide manufacturing quality certification program administered by an independent standards organization. QS9000 is similarly an independently administered manufacturing quality certification used by United States automotive manufacturers. The Company believes that many of its customers prefer to purchase from suppliers who are ISO9002 and QS9000 certified. COMPETITION The independent semiconductor packaging and test industry is very competitive, being comprised of approximately 50 companies, with about 15 of those companies having sales of $100 million per year or more. The Company faces substantial competition from established packaging companies primarily located in Asia, such as Advanced Semiconductor Engineering, Inc. (Taiwan), ASE Test Limited (Taiwan and Malaysia), ASAT Ltd. (Hong Kong), Hana Microelectronics Public Co. Ltd. (Hong Kong and Thailand), Astra International (Indonesia), Carsem Bhd. (Malaysia), ChipPAC Incorporated (Korea), Siliconware Precision Industries Co., Ltd. (Taiwan), and Shinko Electric Industries Co., Ltd. (Japan). Each of these companies has significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research and development operations, marketing and other capabilities, and have been operating for some time. Such companies have also established relationships with many large semiconductor companies which are current or potential customers of the Company. The principal elements of competition in the independent semiconductor packaging market include time to market, breadth of package offering, technical competence, design services, quality, production yields, customer service, and price. The Company believes it generally competes favorably with respect to these factors. On a larger scale, the Company also competes with the internal manufacturing capabilities of many of its largest customers. The independent wafer fabrication business is also highly competitive. The Company expects its wafer fabrication services to compete primarily with independent wafer foundries such as Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing, Ltd., Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company, Ltd. and United Microelectronics Corporation, as well as with device manufacturers such as LG Semicon Co., Ltd., Hitachi, Ltd., Toshiba Corp. and Winbond Electronics Corporation, which provide foundry services for other semiconductor companies. Each of these companies has significant manufacturing capacity, financial resources, research and development operations, marketing and other capabilities and have been operating for some time. Many of these companies have also established relationships with many large semiconductor companies which are current or potential customers of the Company. The principal elements of competition in the wafer foundry market include technology, delivery cycle times, price, product performance, quality, production yield, responsiveness and flexibility, reliability and the ability to design and incorporate product improvements. See "Risk Factors -- Competition." RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT The Company's research and development efforts are focused on developing new package designs and process capabilities, and on improving the efficiency and capabilities of its existing production processes and materials. The Company believes that technology development is one of the key success factors in the packaging market and believes that it has a distinct advantage in this area. In addition to its internal development work, and its co-development work with AICL, the Company also works closely with its packaging equipment and raw material suppliers in developing advanced processing capabilities and materials for use in the Company's production process. Currently, the Company is focusing on development programs 59 61 that extend the capability and applicability of the BGA packaging format. These include high performance BGAs for microprocessors and other high-end devices, and a chip size package for memory. In addition, the Company is aggressively developing a flip-chip die attach and connect process for its laminate packages that has the potential to reduce packaging size and cost and improve package performance significantly. The flip-chip packaging process involves attaching the die I/O terminals directly to the lead circuits on the substrate without the use of gold wires. In addition to providing a smaller package size, this process is expected to result in significant improvements in packaging yields by eliminating the delicate wire bonds from the package. As of March 31, 1998, the Company employed approximately 95 persons in research and development activities. In addition, other management and operational personnel are involved in research and development activities. In 1995, 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, the Company's research and development expenses were approximately $8.7 million, $10.9 million, $8.5 million and $2.1 million, respectively. The Company expects to continue to invest significant resources in research and development. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY The Company currently holds 24 U.S. patents, five of which are jointly held with AICL, related to various IC packaging technologies, in addition to other pending patents. These patents will expire at various dates from 2012 through 2016. With respect to development work undertaken jointly with AICL, the Company and AICL share intellectual property rights under the terms of the Supply Agreements between the Company and AICL. The Supply Agreements also provide for the cross-licensing of intellectual property rights between the Company and AICL. In addition, the Company enters into agreements with other developers of packaging technology to license or otherwise obtain certain process or packaging technologies. The Company expects to continue to file patent applications when appropriate to protect its proprietary technologies; however, the Company believes that its continued success depends primarily on factors such as the technological skills and innovation of its personnel rather than on its patents. The process of seeking patent protection can be expensive and time consuming. There can be no assurance that patents will be issued from pending or future applications or that, if patents are issued, they will not be challenged, invalidated or circumvented, or that rights granted thereunder will provide meaningful protection or other commercial advantage to the Company. Moreover, there can be no assurance that any patent rights will be upheld in the future or that the Company will be able to preserve any of its other intellectual property rights. Although the Company is not currently a party to any material litigation, the semiconductor industry is characterized by frequent claims regarding patent and other intellectual property rights. As is typical in the semiconductor industry, the Company may receive communications from third parties asserting patents on certain of the Company's technologies. In the event any third party were to make a valid claim against the Company or AICL, the Company or AICL could be required to discontinue the use of certain processes or cease the manufacture, use, import and sale of infringing products to pay substantial damages and to develop non-infringing technologies or to acquire licenses to the alleged infringed technology. The Company's business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected by such developments. Litigation, which could result in substantial cost to and diversion of resources of the Company, may also be necessary to enforce patents or other intellectual property rights of the Company or to defend the Company against claimed infringement of the rights of others. The failure to obtain necessary licenses or the occurrence of litigation relating to patent infringement or other intellectual property matters could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, AICL has obtained intellectual property for wafer manufacturing primarily from TI. The licenses granted to AICL by TI under the TI Technology Agreements are very limited. Although TI has granted to AICL a license under TI's trade secret rights to use TI's technology in connection with AICL's provision of wafer fabrication services, TI has not granted AICL a license under its patents, copyrights and mask works to manufacture semiconductors for third parties. Although TI has agreed that TI will not assert a claim for patent, copyright or mask work right infringement against AICL or the Company in connection with AICL's manufacture of semiconductor products for third parties, TI has reserved the right to bring such infringement claims against AICL's or the Company's customers with respect to semiconductor products purchased from AICL or the Company. As a result, AICL's and the Company's customers could be subject to patent litigation 60 62 by TI and others, and AICL and the Company could in turn be subject to litigation by such customers and others, in connection with the sale of wafers produced by AICL. Any such litigation could materially and adversely affect AICL's ability to continue to manufacture wafers and AICL's and the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS The semiconductor packaging process involves a significant amount of chemicals and gases which are subject to extensive governmental regulations. For example, liquid waste is produced at the stage at which silicon wafers are diced into chips with the aid of diamond saws and cooled with running water. In addition, excess materials on leads and moldings are removed from packaged semiconductors in the trim and form process. The Company has installed equipment to collect certain solvents used in connection with its manufacturing process and has contracted with independent waste disposal companies to remove such hazardous material. Federal, state and local regulations in the United States, as well as environmental regulations in Korea and the Philippines, impose various controls on the storage, handling, discharge and disposal of chemicals used in the Company's and AICL's manufacturing processes and on the facilities occupied by the Company and AICL. The Company believes that its activities, as well as those of AICL, conform to present environmental and land use regulations applicable to their respective operations and current facilities. Increasing public attention has, however, been focused on the environmental impact of semiconductor manufacturing operations and the risk to neighbors of chemical releases from such operations. There can be no assurance that applicable land use and environmental regulations will not in the future impose the need for additional capital equipment or other process requirements upon the Company or AICL or restrict the Company's or AICL's ability to expand their respective operations. The adoption of new ordinances or similar measures or any failure by the Company or AICL to comply with applicable environment and land use regulations or to restrict the discharge of hazardous substances could subject the Company or AICL to future liability or cause their respective manufacturing operations to be curtailed or suspended. EMPLOYEES As of March 31, 1998, the Company had approximately 9,200 full-time employees, 7,475 of whom were engaged in manufacturing, 1,210 in manufacturing support, 95 in research and development, 210 in marketing and sales, and 210 in finance, business management, and administration. The Company's employees are not represented by any collective bargaining agreement, and the Company has never experienced a work stoppage. The Company believes that its relations with its employees are good. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on Key Personnel and Availability of Skilled Workforce." 61 63 MANAGEMENT EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS The executive officers and directors of the Company and their ages as of December 31, 1997 are as follows:
NAME AGE POSITION ---- --- -------- James J. Kim.............................. 61 Chief Executive Officer and Chairman John N. Boruch............................ 55 President and Director Frank J. Marcucci......................... 62 Chief Financial Officer Eric R. Larson............................ 42 Vice President Michael D. O'Brien........................ 65 Vice President Thomas D. George(1)(2).................... 57 Director Gregory K. Hinckley(1)(2)................. 51 Director
- --------------- (1) Member of Compensation Committee. (2) Member of Audit Committee. James J. Kim. James Kim has served as the Company's Chief Executive Officer since September 1997. Mr. Kim founded AEI in 1968 and has served as its Chairman since 1970. He has also served as the Chairman of the Anam group of companies and a director of AICL since 1992. Mr. Kim is a director of CFM Technologies, Inc. Mr. Kim earned B.S. and M.A. degrees in Economics from the University of Pennsylvania. Mr. Kim is Chairman of The Electronics Boutique, Inc., an electronics retail chain, and Forte Systems, Inc., an information technology, consulting and outsourcing company. John N. Boruch. John Boruch has served as President and a director of the Company since September 1997. Mr. Boruch has served as President of AEI since February 1992. From 1991 to 1992 he served as AEI Corporate Vice President in charge of Sales. Mr. Boruch earned a B.A. in Economics from Cornell University. Mr. Boruch joined the Company in 1984. Frank J. Marcucci. Frank Marcucci has served as the Chief Financial Officer of the Company since September 1997. Mr. Marcucci has served as the Chief Financial Officer of AEI since joining AEI in 1980. Mr. Marcucci earned a B.S. in Business Administration from Duquesne University and an MBA from the University of Pittsburgh. Mr. Marcucci is a Certified Public Accountant. Eric R. Larson. Eric Larson has served as Vice President of the Wafer Fabrication business of the Company since September 1997. Mr. Larson has served as President of Amkor/Anam Semiconductor, a division of AEI, since December 1996. From 1979 to 1996 he worked for the Hewlett-Packard Company ("HP") in various management capacities, most recently as Worldwide Marketing Manager for disk products. In addition, Mr. Larson was the worldwide Manager of Sales and Marketing of the IC Business Division of HP from July 1985 to May 1993. Mr. Larson earned a B.A. in Political Science from Colorado State University and an MBA from the University of Denver. Michael D. O'Brien. Michael O'Brien has served as the Vice President of Packaging and Testing Operations of the Company since September 1997. Mr. O'Brien has served as Corporate Vice President of AEI since 1990. Mr. O'Brien earned a B.S. from Texas A&M University. Mr. O'Brien joined the Company in 1988. Thomas D. George. Mr. George has been a director of the Company since November 1997. Mr. George was Executive Vice President, and President and General Manager, Semiconductor Products Sector ("SPS") of Motorola from April 1993 to May 1997. Prior to that, he held several positions with Motorola, including Executive Vice President and Assistant General Manager, SPS from November 1992 to April 1993 and Senior Vice President and Assistant General Manager, SPS from July 1986 to November 1992. Mr. George is currently retired. 62 64 Gregory K. Hinckley. Mr. Hinckley has been a director of the Company since November 1997. Mr. Hinckley serves as Executive Vice President, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer of Mentor Graphics Corporation since January 1997. From November 1995 until December 1996 he held the position of Senior Vice President with VLSI, a manufacturer of complex ASICs. From August 1992 until December 1996, Mr. Hinckley held the position of Vice President, Finance and Chief Financial Officer with VLSI. From December 1991 until August 1992, he was an independent consultant. Mr. Hinckley is a director of OEC Medical Systems, Inc., a manufacturer of medical imaging equipment. DIRECTOR COMPENSATION Directors who are also employees or officers of the Company do not receive compensation for their services as directors. Non-employee directors are eligible to receive an annual retainer of $15,000 plus per meeting fees of $1,000 per board meeting and $1,000 per committee meeting attended. Directors are reimbursed for travel and related expenses incurred by them in attending board and committee meetings. 1998 Director Option Plan. The Company's 1998 Director Option Plan (the "Director Plan") was adopted by the Board of Directors in January 1998 and was approved by the Company's stockholders in April 1998. The Director Plan became effective immediately prior to the Initial Public Offering. A total of 300,000 shares of Common Stock have been reserved for issuance under the Director Plan. The option grants under the Director Plan are automatic and non-discretionary. The Director Plan provides for an initial grant of options to purchase 15,000 shares of Common Stock to each new nonemployee director of the Company (an "Outside Director") upon the later of the effective date of the Director Plan or the date which such individual first becomes an Outside Director. In addition, each Outside Director will automatically be granted subsequent options to purchase 5,000 shares of Common Stock on each date on which such Outside Director is re-elected by the stockholders of the Company, provided that as of such date such Outside Director has served on the Board of Directors for at least six months. The exercise price of the options is 100% of the fair market value of the Common Stock on the grant date, except that with respect to initial grants to directors on the effective date of the Director Plan the exercise price will be equal 94% of the Initial Public Offering price per share of Common Stock in the Initial Public Offering. The term of each option is ten years. Each option granted to an Outside Director vests as to 33 1/3% of the optioned stock one year after the date of grant, and as to an additional 33 1/3% of the optioned stock on each anniversary of the date of grant, provided that the optionee continues to serve as an Outside Director on such date so that 100% of the optioned stock may be exercisable three years after the date of grant. In the event of the sale of all or substantially all the Company's assets or the merger of the company with or into another corporation, all outstanding options under the Director Plan may either be assumed or an equivalent option may be substituted by the surviving entity. Following such assumption or substitution, if the director is terminated other than upon a voluntary resignation, such assumed or substituted options will vest and become exercisable in full. If no assumption or substitution occurs, each such option will vest and become exercisable in full. The Director Plan will terminate in January 2008 unless sooner terminated by the Board of Directors. BOARD COMMITTEES The Board of Directors has a Compensation Committee and an Audit Committee. The Compensation Committee is comprised of Messrs. George and Hinckley. The functions of the Compensation Committee are to review and approve annual salaries, bonuses, and grants of stock options pursuant to the Company's 1998 Stock Plan and to review and approve the terms and conditions of all employee benefit plans or changes thereto. The Audit Committee is comprised of Messrs. George and Hinckley. The functions of the Audit Committee are to recommend annually to the Board of Directors the appointment of the independent auditors of the Company, discuss and review in advance the scope and the fees of the annual audit and review the results thereof with the independent auditors, review and approve non-audit services of the independent auditors, review compliance with existing major accounting and financial reporting policies of the Company, review the adequacy of the financial organization of the Company, and review management's procedures and policies relating to the adequacy of the Company's internal accounting controls and compliance with applicable laws relating to accounting practices. 63 65 EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION Summary Compensation. The following table sets forth compensation earned during the fiscal year ended December 31, 1997, by the Company's Chief Executive Officer and the four other most highly compensated executive officers whose total salary and bonus during such year exceeded $100,000 (collectively, the "Named Executive Officers"). SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
ANNUAL COMPENSATION(1) ---------------------- ALL OTHER NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITIONS SALARY BONUS COMPENSATION ---------------------------- --------- --------- ------------ James J. Kim, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman(2).......................................... $500,000 $500,000 $ 6,000 John N. Boruch, President(3)........................... 415,000 375,000 6,000 Frank J. Marcucci, Chief Financial Officer(4).......... 254,000 100,000 245,000 Eric R. Larson, Vice President......................... 220,000 -- -- Michael D. O'Brien, Vice President..................... 249,000 100,000 --
- --------------- (1) At the time of the Initial Public Offering, Messrs. Boruch, Marcucci, Larson and O'Brien received option grants of 400,000 shares, 110,000 shares, 90,000 shares and 90,000 shares, respectively, of Common Stock under the Company's 1998 Stock Plan, in each case with an exercise price per share equal to the Initial Public Offering price per share. (2) All other compensation for Mr. Kim represents the amount of insurance premium paid by the Company on Mr. Kim's behalf for a life insurance policy. Effective January 1, 1998, Mr. Kim is compensated at an annual salary of $750,000 and he may earn an annual bonus of up to $500,000 if the Company achieves its annual operating plan, as approved by the Company's Board of Directors. (3) All other compensation for Mr. Boruch represents the amount of insurance premium paid by the Company on Mr. Boruch's behalf for a life insurance policy. (4) All other compensation for Mr. Marcucci represents the amount of insurance premium paid by the Company on Mr. Marcucci's behalf for a life insurance policy together with a bonus paid to Mr. Marcucci to cover the income taxes owed by Mr. Marcucci as a result of the payment of such insurance premium. STOCK PLANS 1998 Stock Plan. The Company's 1998 Stock Plan (the "1998 Plan") provides for the grant to employees of incentive stock options within the meaning of Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (the "Code"), and for the grant to employees, directors and consultants of nonstatutory stock options and stock purchase rights. The 1998 Plan was adopted by the Board of Directors in January 1998 and was approved by the Company's stockholders in April 1998. Unless terminated sooner, the 1998 Plan will terminate automatically in January 2008. The maximum aggregate number of shares which may be optioned and sold under the 1998 Plan is 5,000,000, plus an annual increase to be added on each anniversary date of the adoption of the 1998 Plan equal to the lesser of (i) the number of shares of Common Stock needed to restore the maximum aggregate number of shares of Common Stock which may be optioned and sold under the 1998 to 5,000,000, or (ii) a lesser amount determined by the Board of Directors. The 1998 Plan may be administered by the Board of Directors or a committee appointed by the Board of Directors (the "Committee"), which Committee shall, in the case of options intended to qualify as "performance-based compensation" within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code, consist of two or more "outside directors" within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code. The Board of Directors or the Committee, as applicable, has the power to determine the terms of options granted, including the exercise price and the fair market value, to reduce the exercise price of any option to the then current fair market price if the fair market value of the Common Stock covered by such option shall have declined since the date the option was granted, the number of shares subject to the option or stock purchase right, and the exercisability thereof and the form of consideration payable upon such exercise. In addition, the Board of Directors has the 64 66 authority to amend, suspend or terminate the 1998 Plan, provided that no such action may affect any share of Common Stock previously issued and sold or any option previously granted under the 1998 Plan. Unless determined otherwise by the administrators, options and stock purchase rights granted under the 1998 Plan are not transferable by the optionee, and each option and stock purchase right is generally exercisable during the lifetime of the optionee only by such optionee. Options granted under the 1998 Plan must generally be exercised within 30 days following termination of an optionee's status as an employee, director or consultant of the Company, within twelve months after an optionee's termination by disability, and within twelve months after an optionee's termination by death, but in no event later than the expiration of the option. In the case of stock purchase rights, unless the administrator determines otherwise, a restricted stock purchase agreement shall grant the Company a repurchase option exercisable upon the voluntary or involuntary termination of the purchaser's employment with the Company for any reason (including death or disability). The purchase price for shares repurchased pursuant to a restricted stock purchase agreement shall be the original price paid by the purchaser and may be paid by cancellation of any indebtedness of the purchaser to the Company. The repurchase option shall lapse at a rate determined by the administrator. The exercise price of all incentive stock options granted under the 1998 Plan must be at least equal to the fair market value of the shares on the date of grant. The exercise price of nonstatutory stock options granted under the 1998 Plan is determined by the Committee, but with respect to nonstatutory stock options intended to qualify as "performance-based compensation" within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code, the exercise price must be at least equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock on the date of grant. With respect to any employee who owns stock possessing more than ten percent of the voting power of all classes of the Company's, or any parent or subsidiary of the Company's outstanding capital stock, the exercise price of any incentive stock option granted to such person must equal at least 110% of the fair market value of the Common Stock on the date of grant and the term of such incentive stock option must not exceed five years. The term of all other options granted under the 1998 Plan may not exceed ten years. The 1998 Plan provides that in the event of a merger of the Company with or into another corporation, or a sale of substantially all of the Company's assets, each outstanding option and stock purchase right will be assumed or substituted for by the successor corporation. In the event the successor corporation refuses to assume or substitute for the option or stock purchase right, the optionee shall have the right to exercise all of the optioned stock, including shares as to which it would not otherwise be exercisable. 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees. The 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees (the "French Plan") was approved by the Board of Directors in April 1998. Unless terminated sooner, the French Plan will continue in existence for 5 years. The French Plan provides for the granting of options to employees of Amkor/Anam EuroServices S.A.R.L. and Amkor Wafer Fabrication Services SARL, the Company's French subsidiaries (the "French Subsidiaries"). A total of 250,000 shares of Common Stock have been reserved for issuance under the French Plan plus an annual increase to be added on each anniversary date of the adoption of the French Plan equal to the lesser of (i) the number of shares of Common Stock needed to restore the maximum aggregate number of shares of Common Stock which may be optioned and sold under the French Plan to 250,000, or (ii) a lesser amount determined by the Board of Directors. Options granted under the French Plan are not transferable by the optionee other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution. The exercise price for each option granted under the French Plan shall be 100% of the fair market value of the shares of Common Stock on the date the option is granted and the maximum term of the option must not exceed ten years. Stock options granted under the French Plan vest over a five year period with 50% of the shares subject to cash options vesting on the second anniversary of the vesting commencement date and 1/24 of the remaining shares subject to each option vesting each month thereafter. Shares subject to the options granted under the French Plan may not be transferred, assigned or hypothecated in any manner other than by will or the laws of descent or distribution before the date which is five years after the date of grant. The French Plan may be administered by the Board of Directors or a committee appointed by the Board of Directors (the "Committee"). The Board of Directors or the Committee, as applicable, has the power to determine the terms of options granted, including the exercise price and the fair market value the number of 65 67 shares subject to the option and the exercisability thereof and the form of consideration payable upon such exercise. In addition, the Board of Directors has the authority to amend, suspend or terminate the French Plan, provided that no such action may affect any share of Common Stock previously issued and sold or any option previously granted under the French Plan. Unless determined otherwise by the administrators, options granted under the French Plan are not transferable by the optionee, and each option is generally exercisable during the lifetime of the optionee only by such optionee. Options granted under the French Plan must generally be exercised within 30 days following termination of an optionee's status as an employee of either of the French Subsidiaries, within six months after an optionee's termination by disability, and within six months after an optionee's termination by death, but in no event later than the expiration of the option. The term of all options granted under the French Plan may not exceed ten years. The French Plan provides that in the event of a merger of the Company with or into another corporation, or a sale of substantially all of the Company's assets, each outstanding option will be assumed or substituted for by the successor corporation. In the event the successor corporation refuses to assume or substitute for the option, the optionee shall have the right to exercise all of the optioned stock, including shares as to which it would not otherwise be exercisable. 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. The Company's 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the "Purchase Plan") was adopted by the Board of Directors in January 1998 and was approved by the stockholders in April 1998. The Board of Directors has not set an effective date for the Purchase Plan. A total of 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock have been made available for sale under the Purchase Plan and an annual increase is to be added on each anniversary date of the adoption of the Purchase Plan equal to the lesser of (i) the number of shares needed to restore the maximum aggregate number of shares available for sale under the Purchase Plan to 1,000,000, or (ii) a lesser amount determined by the Board of Directors. The Purchase Plan, which is intended to qualify under Section 423 of the Code is administered by the Board of Directors or by a committee appointed by the Board. Employees (including officers and employee directors of the Company but excluding 5% or greater stockholders) are eligible to participate if they are customarily employed for at least 20 hours per week and for more than five months in any calendar year. The Purchase Plan permits eligible employees to purchase Common Stock through payroll deductions, which may not exceed 15% of the compensation an employee receives on each pay day. The Purchase Plan will be implemented by consecutive six-month offering periods. The initial offering period and the date of subsequent offering periods under the Purchase Plan will be determined by the Board of Directors after the effective date of the Initial Public Offering. Each participant will be granted an option on the first day of an offering period, and shares of Common Stock will be automatically purchased on the last date of each purchase period within the offering period. If the fair market value of the Common Stock on any purchase date (other than the final purchase date of the offering period) is lower than such fair market value on the start date of that offering period, then all participants in that offering period will be automatically withdrawn from such offering period and re-enrolled in the immediately following offering period. The purchase price of the Common Stock under the Purchase Plan will be equal to 85% of the lesser of the fair market value per share of Common Stock on the start date of the offering period or on the purchase date. Employees may end their participation in an offering period at any time, and participation ends automatically on termination of employment with the Company. In the event of a proposed dissolution or liquidation of the Company, the offering periods then in progress will be shortened by setting a new exercise date that is before the dissolution or liquidation, and will terminate immediately prior to the consummation of the proposed action, unless otherwise provided by the Board. In the event of a proposed sale of all or substantially all of the Company's assets or the merger of the Company with or into another corporation, each outstanding option will be assumed or substituted for by the successor corporation. In the event the successor corporation refuses to assume or substitute for the options, the offering periods then in progress will be shortened by setting a new exercise date that is before the sale or merger and the offering periods then in progress will end on the new exercise date. Each participant will be notified at least ten business days prior to the new exercise date, and unless such participant ends his or her participation, the option will be exercised automatically on the new exercise date. The Purchase Plan will terminate in January 2008, unless sooner terminated by the Board of Directors. 66 68 401(k) PLAN The Company participates in a tax-qualified employee savings and retirement plan (the "401(k) Plan") which covers certain of the Company's employees who are at least 21 years of age. Pursuant to the 401(k) Plan, employees may elect to reduce their current eligible compensation by up to 13% of eligible compensation or the statutorily prescribed annual limit, whichever is lower, and have the amount of such reduction contributed to the 401(k) Plan. After an eligible employee completes one year of service and has attained age 21, he or she will become eligible for the Company matching contributions effective as of the quarterly entry date after meeting these service and age requirements. The matching contribution amount is a discretionary amount as determined from time to time by the Company. The 401(k) Plan is intended to qualify under Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, so that contributions by employees or by the Company to the 401(k) Plan, and income earned on plan contributions, are not taxable to employees until withdrawn from the 401(k) Plan, and so that contributions by the Company, if any, will be deductible by the Company when made. The trustee under the 401(k) Plan, at the direction of each participant, invests the assets of the 401(k) Plan in any of a number of designated investment options. PHILIPPINE PENSION PLANS The Company adopted a retirement plan for its eligible Philippine employees and those eligible employees of designated affiliated companies and subsidiaries of the Company, the Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Incorporated Employees' Retirement Benefit Plan (the "Phillipine Plan"), originally effective January 1, 1988, and most recently amended on January 1, 1997. Eligible employees are employees with regular and permanent status that have been employed continuously for one (1) year by a participating company. Currently, the companies participating in the Phillipine Plan are AMI, AAAP, and Anam Amkor Precision Machine Company (Phils.), Incorporated. At normal retirement age (age 60), death, or upon total and permanent disability, a participant will receive a lump sum benefit payment based on a percentage of his or her final base monthly salary, as determined by his or her years of credited service. A participant who retires at age 50 with at least ten (10) years of service will receive a reduced payment based on the same formula. Company contributions to the Phillipine Plan are held in trust. The Phillipine Plan is presently underfunded by $3.8 million. The amount by which the Phillipine Plan is underfunded decreased from $7.2 million at September 30, 1997 primarily as a result of payments made by the Company as required under the plan and the effect of the recent devaluation of the Phillipine peso to the U.S. dollar. See Note 9 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. LIMITATIONS ON LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION MATTERS The Company has adopted provisions in its Certificate of Incorporation that eliminate to the fullest extent permissible under Delaware law the liability of its directors to the Company for monetary damages. Such limitation of liability does not affect the availability of equitable remedies such as injunctive relief or rescission. The Bylaws provide that the Company shall indemnify its directors and officers, and may indemnify its other employees and agents, to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law, including in circumstances in which indemnification is otherwise discretionary under Delaware law. The Company has entered into indemnification agreements with its officers and directors containing provisions which may require the Company, among other things, to indemnify the officers and directors against certain liabilities that may arise by reason of their status or service as directors or officers (other than liabilities arising from willful misconduct of a culpable nature), and to advance their expenses incurred as a result of any proceeding against them as to which they could be indemnified. There is no currently pending litigation or proceeding involving a director, officer, employee or other agent of the Company in which indemnification would be required or permitted. 67 69 CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS AICL was founded in 1956 by Mr. H. S. Kim, who currently serves as the honorary Chairman and a Representative Director of AICL. AICL is a member of the Anam Group of companies, consisting principally of companies in Korea in the electronics industries. The management of AICL and the other companies in the Anam Group are influenced to a significant degree by the family of H. S. Kim, which, together with the Company, collectively owned approximately 40.7% of the outstanding common stock of AICL as of December 31, 1997. A significant portion of the shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or for other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. James Kim, the founder of the Company and currently its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, is the eldest son of H. S. Kim. Since January 1992, in addition to his other responsibilities, James Kim has been serving as acting Chairman of the Anam Group and a director of AICL. Mr. In-Kil Hwang, the President and a Representative Director of AICL, is the brother-in-law of James Kim. In addition, four other members of Mr. Kim's family are on the 13-member Board of Directors of AICL. In connection with the Reorganization, Mr. James Kim and members of his family exchanged their interests in the Amkor Companies in return for shares of Common Stock. James Kim and members of his family beneficially own approximately 65.8% of the outstanding Common Stock, and Mr. Kim and other members of his family will continue to exercise significant control over the Company. The Company and AICL have had a long-standing relationship. In 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 72%, 68% and 67%, respectively, of the Company's revenues were derived from sales of services performed for the Company by AICL. In addition, substantially all of the revenues of AICL in 1996, 1997 and the three months ended March 31, 1998 were derived from services sold by the Company. The Company expects that the businesses of the Company and AICL will continue to remain highly interdependent by virtue of their supply relationship, overlaps and family ties between their respective shareholders and management, financial relationships, coordination of product and operation plans, joint research and development activities and shared intellectual property rights. See "Relationship with AICL" and "Reorganization." The Company has entered into indemnification agreements with its officers and directors containing provisions which may require the Company, among other things, to indemnify the officers and directors against certain liabilities that may arise by reason of their status or service as directors or officers (other than liabilities arising from willful misconduct of a culpable nature), and to advance to them expenses incurred as a result of any proceeding against them as to which they could be indemnified. In connection with the Reorganization, the Company has entered into tax indemnification agreements with Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts pursuant to which the Company will be indemnified by such stockholders with respect to their proportionate share of any U.S. federal or state corporate income taxes attributable to the failure of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period or in any jurisdiction for which S Corporation status was claimed through the Termination Date. The tax indemnification agreements also provide that under certain circumstances the Company will indemnify Mr. and Mrs. Kim and the Kim Family Trusts if such stockholders are required to pay additional taxes or other amounts attributable to taxable years on or before the Termination Date as to which AEI filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation. AEI has made various distributions to such stockholders which have enabled them to pay their income taxes on their allocable portions of the income of AEI. Such distributions totaled approximately $13.0 million and $5.0 million in 1996 and 1997, respectively. No distributions were made to such stockholders in the first three months of 1998. The Company declared additional distributions to such stockholders prior to the consummation of the Reorganization in an amount equal to AEI's and Amkor Technology, Inc.'s cumulative net income in all periods prior to the Termination Date less the aggregate amount of distributions previously made to such stockholders. These final distributions are intended to provide such stockholders with the balance of AEI's and Amkor Technology, Inc.'s net income for which they have already recognized taxable income. Through March 31, 1998, the amount of such undistributed net earnings was $35.7 million. Subsequent to March 31, 1998, aggregate distributors of $33.1 million were made to such stockholders. See "Reorganization" and Notes 1, 10 and 17 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 68 70 In February 1998 the Company sold its investment in AICL common stock to AK Investments, Inc. ("AK Investments"), a company owned by Mr. Kim, for $13.9 million, the market value determined by the closing price of AICL shares on the Korea Stock Exchange on the date of the sale. In exchange for such shares, AK Investments assumed $13.9 million of the Company's long-term borrowing from AUSA. See Note 6 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Mr. Kim has executed certain guarantees to lenders in connection with certain debt instruments of the Amkor Companies that remain outstanding. The total contingent liability under such guarantees equalled approximately $79 million as of March 31, 1998. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. The Company and Mr. Kim currently are parties to a loan agreement under which Mr. Kim may borrow funds from the Company, subject to the Company's consent. Mr. Kim has recognized compensation in 1996 and 1997 in the amount of $101,716 and $3,000, respectively of imputed interest for loans under this agreement. Since the beginning of the 1996 fiscal year, the maximum amount outstanding under such agreement has been $6.5 million. All amounts due from Mr. Kim have been repaid in full subsequent to December 31, 1997. In 1996, Mr. Kim sold his interest in Amkor Anam Test Services, Inc., representing half of its outstanding capital stock, to AEI for $910,350. See Note 14 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. AK Investments purchased certain securities held by AEI for $49.7 million, which consideration was paid by assuming from AEI certain non-current payables from AUSA. Subsequent to the sale of investments to AK Investments, AEI loaned AK Investments an additional $12.8 million. This loan was repaid in full as of March 31, 1998. See Notes 6 and 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. AK Investments repaid such amount in full during March 1998. In 1996, the Kim Family Trusts borrowed $5.3 million at market interest rates from AEI to purchase the real estate and develop the facilities that comprise the Company's Chandler, Arizona plant and offices. In 1997, the Kim Family Trusts, after making improvements, sold the real estate and facilities back to AEI for $5.7 million which was used to repay the original loan from AEI. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Members of the Kim family own all the outstanding shares of Forte Systems, Inc. ("Forte"). The Company and Forte currently are parties to a loan agreement under which Forte may borrow funds at market interest rates from the Company, subject to the Company's consent. Since the beginning of the 1996 fiscal year, the maximum amount outstanding under such agreement has been $3.8 million. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. Members of the Kim family own all the outstanding shares of The Electronics Boutique, Inc. (the "Electronics Boutique"). The Company and the Electronics Boutique currently are parties to a loan agreement under which the Electronics Boutique may borrow funds at market rates from the Company, subject to the Company's consent. Since the beginning of the 1996 fiscal year, the maximum amount outstanding under such agreement in the ordinary course of business of the Electronics Boutique's business has been $3.0 million. In addition, in 1996, the Electronics Boutique borrowed $50 million from AEI in connection with a contemplated acquisition. However, this acquisition was abandoned by the Electronics Boutique and the $50 million was repaid to AEI within eleven working days of the date it was borrowed. Finally, the Company has guaranteed certain vendor obligations and a line of credit of the Electronics Boutique, which total approximately $5.7 million and $3.8 million, respectively as of March 31, 1998. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. In addition, in each of the last three years, various Electronics Boutique expenses were paid by the Company on behalf of Electronics Boutique and various Company expenses were paid by Electronics Boutique on behalf of the Company. These expenses include insurance premiums, employee medical claims, interest, rent and other miscellaneous expenses. In 1995, 1996 and 1997, the Company made net advancements on behalf of Electronics Boutique of $604,000, $128,000 and $147,000. In 1997, Electronics Boutique repaid to the Company $2.4 million of current and prior year advancements. 69 71 The Company has also unconditionally guaranteed obligations of EB Canada, a subsidiary of Electronics Boutique, under a $4 million term loan agreement and a $1 million line of credit. As of March 31, 1998, there was $3.8 million outstanding under the term loan and no amounts outstanding under the line of credit. The Company leases office space in West Chester, Pennsylvania from the Kim Family Trusts. The lease expires in 2006. The Company has the option to extend the lease for an additional 10 years. The monthly rent pursuant to such lease is $92,000. The Company sub-leases a portion of this office space to Forte for which the monthly rent is $43,000. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. At December 31, 1996 and 1997 and March 31, 1998, the Company had advances and notes receivable from affiliates other than AICL and AUSA of $23.0 million, $36.5 million and $27.0 million, respectively. See Note 11 of Notes to Combined Financial Statements. 70 72 PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS The following table sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial ownership of the Common Stock outstanding as of the date of this Prospectus, by (i) each person or entity who is known by the Company to own beneficially 5% or more of the Company's outstanding Common Stock; (ii) each director of the Company; (iii) each of the Named Executive Officers; and (iv) all directors and executive officers of the Company as a group.
BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP(1) ----------------------- NAME AND ADDRESS NUMBER PERCENT ---------------- ----------- -------- James J. and Agnes C. Kim(2)(3)(4).......................... 32,275,000 27.38% 1345 Enterprise Drive West Chester, PA 19380 David D. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987(3)(5)............... 13,750,000 11.67 1500 E. Lancaster Avenue Paoli, PA 19301 John T. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987(3)(5)................ 13,750,000 11.67 1500 E. Lancaster Avenue Paoli, PA 19301 Susan Y. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987(3)(5)(6)............ 13,750,000 11.67 1500 E. Lancaster Avenue Paoli, PA 19301 Thomas D. George............................................ -- -- Gregory K. Hinckley......................................... -- -- John N. Boruch.............................................. -- -- Eric R. Larson.............................................. -- -- Frank J. Marcucci........................................... -- -- Michael D. O'Brien.......................................... -- -- All directors and executive officers as a group (7 persons).................................................. 32,275,000 27.38
- --------------- (1) The number and percentage of shares beneficially owned is determined in accordance with Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), and the information is not necessarily indicative of beneficial ownership for any other purpose. Under such rule, beneficial ownership includes any share as to which the individual or entity has voting power or investment power. Unless otherwise indicated, each person or entity has sole voting and investment power with respect to shares shown as beneficially owned. (2) James J. and Agnes C. Kim are husband and wife. Accordingly, each may be deemed to beneficially own shares of Common Stock held in the name of the other. (3) David D. Kim, John T. Kim and Susan Y. Kim are children of James J. and Agnes C. Kim. Each of the David D. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987, John T. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987 and Susan Y. Kim Trust of December 31, 1987 has in common Susan Y. Kim and John F.A. Earley as co-trustees, in addition to a third trustee (John T. Kim in the case of the Susan Y. Kim Trust and the John T. Kim Trust and David D. Kim in the case of the David D. Kim Trust) (the trustees of each trust may be deemed to be the beneficial owners of the shares held by such trust). In addition, the trust agreement for each of these trusts encourages the trustees of the trusts to vote the shares of Common Stock held by them, in their discretion, in concert with James Kim's family. Accordingly, the trusts, together with their respective trustees and James J. and Agnes C. Kim, may be considered a "group" under Section 13(d) of the Exchange Act. This group may be deemed to have beneficial ownership of 73,525,000 shares or 62.4% of the outstanding shares of Common Stock after the Initial Public Offering. (4) Salomon Smith Barney may, subject to certain limitations, from time to time, borrow shares of Common Stock from Mr. and Mrs. Kim to settle short sales of Common Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Salomon Smith Barney to settle such short sales) entered into by Salomon Smith Barney to hedge any long position in the Convertible Notes resulting from its market-making activities; provided that the total number of shares borrowed at any time may not exceed 7,000,000. See "Plan of 71 73 Distribution." If at any time 7,000,000 shares are borrowed from Mr. and Mrs. Kim and sold and not returned, their beneficial ownership of the Common Stock would be reduced to 20.2%. (5) These three trusts together with the trusts described in note (6) below comprise the Kim Family Trusts. (6) Includes 8,200,000 shares held by a trust established for the benefit of Susan Y. Kim's children. 72 74 DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK GENERAL The Company is authorized to issue 500,000,000 shares of Common Stock, $.001 par value, and 10,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock, $.001 par value. As of the date of this Prospectus, there are an aggregate of 117,860,000 shares of Common Stock outstanding, 3,145,900 shares of Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding options, 3,404,100 shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under the Company's 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees, 1998 Director Option Plan and 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan and 15,333,333 shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance upon conversion of the Convertible Notes. The following description of the Company's capital stock does not purport to be complete and is subject to and qualified in its entirety by the Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws, which are included as exhibits to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part, and by the provisions of applicable Delaware law. The Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws contain certain provisions that are intended to enhance the likelihood of continuity and stability in the composition of the Board of Directors and which may have the effect of delaying, deferring, or preventing a future takeover or change in control of the Company unless such takeover or change in control is approved by the Board of Directors. COMMON STOCK Holders of Common Stock are entitled to one vote per share on all matters to be voted upon by the stockholders. Holders of Common Stock do not have cumulative voting rights, and, therefore, holders of a majority of the shares voting for the election of directors can elect all of the directors. In such event, the holders of the remaining shares will not be able to elect any directors. See "Risk Factors -- Benefits of the Initial Public Offering to Existing Stockholders; Continued Control by Existing Stockholders." Holders of the Common Stock are entitled to receive such dividends as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors out of funds legally available therefor, subject to the terms of any existing or future agreements between the Company and its debtholders. The Company has never declared or paid cash dividends on its capital stock, expects to retain future earnings, if any, for use in the operation and expansion of its business, and does not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. See "Dividend Policy." In the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company, the holders of Common Stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets legally available for distribution after payment of all debts and other liabilities and subject to the prior rights of any holders of Preferred Stock then outstanding. PREFERRED STOCK The Company's Board of Directors is authorized to issue 10,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock in one or more series and to fix the price, rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions thereof, including dividend rights, dividend rates, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of redemption, redemption prices, liquidation preferences and the number of shares constituting a series or the designation of such series, without any further vote or action by the Company's stockholders. The issuance of Preferred Stock, while providing desirable flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions and other corporate purposes, could have the effect of delaying, deferring or making more difficult a change in control of the Company and may adversely affect the market price of, and the voting and other rights of, the holders of Common Stock. The issuance of Preferred Stock with voting and conversion rights may adversely affect the voting power of the holders of Common Stock, including the loss of voting control to others. The Company has no current plans to issue any additional shares of Preferred Stock. See "Risk Factors -- Anti-Takeover Effects of Delaware Law and Certain Charter Provisions." 73 75 EFFECT OF DELAWARE ANTI-TAKEOVER STATUTE The Company is subject to Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the "Anti-Takeover Law"), which regulates corporate acquisitions. The Anti-Takeover Law prevents certain Delaware corporations, including those whose securities are listed for trading on the Nasdaq National Market, from engaging, under certain circumstances in a "business combination" with any "interested stockholder" for three years following the date that such stockholder became an interested stockholder. For purposes of the Anti-Takeover Law, a "business combination" includes, among other things, a merger or consolidation involving the Company and the interested shareholder and the sale of more than 10% of the Company's assets. In general, the Anti-Takeover Law defines an "interested stockholder" as any entity or person beneficially owning 15% or more the outstanding voting stock of the Company and any entity or person affiliated with or controlling or controlled by such entity or person. A Delaware corporation may "opt out" of the Anti-Takeover Law with an express provision in its original certificate of incorporation or an express provision in its certificate of incorporation or bylaws resulting from amendments approved by the holders of at least a majority of the Company's outstanding voting shares. The Company has not "opted out" of the provisions of the Anti-Takeover Law. See "Risk Factors -- Anti-Takeover Effects of Delaware Law and Certain Charter Provisions." TRANSFER AGENT The Transfer Agent and Registrar for the Common Stock is First Chicago Trust Company of New York Shareholder Services, 525 Washington Boulevard, Jersey City, NJ 07310; telephone (201) 324-0014. 74 76 SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE Prior to the Initial Public Offering, there had been no market for the Common Stock and there is no assurance that a significant public market for the Common Stock will be sustained. Sales of substantial amounts of Common Stock in the public market could adversely affect the market price of the Common Stock and could impair the Company's future ability to raise capital through the sale of its equity securities. As of the date of this Prospectus, the Company has outstanding 117,860,000 shares of Common Stock. In addition to the 40,250,000 shares of Common Stock offered pursuant to the Initial Public Offering, there are approximately 15,333,333 shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of the Convertible Notes, all of which will be freely tradeable. In addition, Salomon Smith Barney may, subject to certain limitations, from time to time, borrow shares of Common Stock from Mr. and Mrs. Kim to settle short sales of Common Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Salomon Smith Barney to settle such short sales) entered into by Salomon Smith Barney to hedge any long position in the Convertible Notes resulting from its market-making activities; provided that the total number of shares borrowed at any time may not exceed 7,000,000. Salomon Smith Barney is not under any obligation to engage in any market-making transactions with respect to the Convertible Notes, and any market-making in the Convertible Notes actually engaged in by Salomon Smith Barney may cease at any time. See "Plan of Distribution." The shares of Common Stock borrowed and returned to Mr. and Mrs. Kim (the "Control Shares") may be resold from time to time by Mr. and Mrs. Kim subject to certain volume, manner of sale and other restrictions described below under Rule 144 under the Securities Act. Excluding all such freely tradeable shares and Control Shares, approximately 70,610,000 additional shares of Common Stock will be outstanding upon the closing of the Initial Public Offering (excluding 3,145,900 shares issuable upon the exercise of outstanding options), all of which are "restricted" shares (the "Restricted Shares") under the Securities Act. Such Restricted Shares may be sold only if registered under the Securities Act or sold in accordance with an available exemption from such registration. Under Rule 144, a person (or persons whose shares are aggregated in accordance with the Rule) who has beneficially owned his or her Restricted Shares for at least one year, including persons who are affiliates of the Company, will be entitled to sell, within any three month period a number of Restricted Shares that does not exceed the greater of (i) one percent of the then outstanding number of shares of Common Stock (1,178,600 shares of Common Stock immediately after the consummation of the Initial Public Offering) or (ii) the average weekly trading volume of the shares of Common Stock during the four calendar weeks preceding each such sale. In addition, sales under Rule 144 are also subject to certain manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the availability of current public information about the Company. After Restricted Shares are held for two years, a person who is not an affiliate of the Company is entitled to sell such shares under Rule 144 without regard to such volume limitations, or manner of sale, notice or public information requirements under Rule 144. Sales of Restricted Shares by affiliates will continue to be subject to such volume limitations, and manner of sale, notice and public information requirements. In connection with the Initial Public Offering, the Company agreed with the Underwriters not to offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, or otherwise dispose of (or enter into any transaction which is designed to, or could be expected to, result in the disposition (whether by actual disposition or effective economic disposition due to cash settlement or otherwise) by the Company or any affiliate of the Company or any person in privity with the Company or any affiliate of the Company), directly or indirectly, or announce the offering of, any other shares of Common Stock or any securities or options convertible into, or exchangeable or exercisable for, shares of Common Stock (other than the Convertible Notes) for a period of 180 days following April 30, 1998 without the prior written consent of Salomon Smith Barney, subject to certain limited exceptions. In addition, each of the Company's officers, directors and stockholders has agreed with the Underwriters not to offer, sell, contract to sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of, or file a registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission in respect of, or establish or increase a put equivalent position or liquidate or decrease a call equivalent position within the meaning of Section 16 of the Exchange Act with respect to, any shares of Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for shares of Common Stock, or publicly announce an intention to effect any such transaction, for a period of 180 days after April 30, 1998 75 77 other than pursuant to the Securities Loan Agreement or with the prior written consent of Salomon Smith Barney, subject to certain limited exceptions. Beginning April 29, 1999, approximately 70,610,000 Restricted Shares subject to the lock-up agreements will become eligible for sale in the public market pursuant to Rule 144. The Company has granted options to purchase 3,145,900 shares of Common Stock under the 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees and the 1998 Director Option Plan. See "Management -- Stock Plans." The Company intends to file, within 30 days after the date of the commencement of the Initial Public Offering, a Form S-8 registration statement under the Securities Act to register shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under the 1998 Stock Plan, 1998 Director Option Plan and 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, and shares of Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding options. Shares of Common Stock issued upon exercise of options after the effective date of the Form S-8 will be available for sale in the public market, subject to Rule 144 volume limitations applicable to affiliates and to lock-up agreements. PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION Mr. and Mrs. Kim (referred to herein as the "Lender") and Salomon Smith Barney have entered into a Securities Loan Agreement (the "Securities Loan Agreement") which provides that, subject to certain restrictions and with the agreement of the Lender, Salomon Smith Barney may from time to time borrow, return and reborrow shares of Common Stock from the Lender (the "Borrowed Securities"); provided, however, that the number of Borrowed Securities at any time may not exceed 7,000,000 shares, subject to adjustment to provide antidilution protection. The Securities Loan Agreement is intended to facilitate market-making activity in the Convertible Notes by Salomon Smith Barney. Salomon Smith Barney may, subject to certain limitations, from time to time use Borrowed Securities to settle short sales of Common Stock (or to return Common Stock previously borrowed by Salomon Smith Barney to settle such short sales) entered into by Salomon Smith Barney to hedge any long position in the Convertible Notes resulting from its market-making activities. Such sales will be made on the Nasdaq National Market or in the over-the-counter market at market prices prevailing at the time of sale or at prices related to such market prices. Market conditions will dictate the extent and timing of Salomon Smith Barney's market-making transactions in the Convertible Notes and the consequent need to borrow shares of Common Stock. The availability of shares of Common Stock under the Securities Loan Agreement, if any, at any time is not assured and any such availability does not assure market-making activity with respect to the Convertible Notes. Any market-making actually engaged in by Salomon Smith Barney may cease at any time. The foregoing description of the Securities Loan Agreement does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to such agreement, the form of which is filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part. The Lender and the Company have agreed to indemnify Salomon Smith Barney against certain liabilities including liabilities under the Securities Act. In the ordinary course of business, Salomon Smith Barney has engaged in investment banking transactions with the Company (including as an Underwriter of the Initial Public Offering), Mr. and Mrs. Kim and their respective affiliates and may do so in the future. LEGAL MATTERS The validity of the Common Stock offered hereby will be passed upon for the Company by Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation, Palo Alto, California. 76 78 EXPERTS The combined financial statements and schedule of Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc. as of December 31, 1996 and 1997, and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1997, included in this Prospectus and elsewhere in this Registration Statement have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public accountants, as set forth in their reports dated February 3, 1998 (except with respect to the sale of the investment in Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. ("AICL") common stock discussed in Note 6 to the Combined Financial Statements, as to which the date is February 16, 1998, the Reorganization discussed in Note 16, as to which the date is April 29, 1998 and the Initial Public Offering discussed in Note 16, as to which the date is May 8, 1998) with respect thereto, and are included herein in reliance upon the authority of said firm as experts in giving said reports. In those reports, such firm states that with respect to the investment in AICL its opinion is based on the report of other independent public accountants, namely Samil Accounting Corporation. The consolidated financial statements of AICL as of December 31, 1996 and 1997, and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1997 (not included in this Prospectus or elsewhere in this Registration Statement) have been audited by Samil Accounting Corporation, independent public accountants, as set forth in their report dated March 20, 1998 with respect thereto, which report is included herein in reliance upon the authority of said firm as experts. In that report, such firm states that with respect to Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd. ("AEC") and AUSA, subsidiaries of AICL, and the investment in AAP, its opinion is based on the reports of other independent public accountants, namely Chong Un & Company, Siana, Carr and O'Connor, LLP and SyCip Gorres, Velayo & Co, respectively. Reference is made to the report regarding AEC which includes an explanatory paragraph with respect to the ability of AEC to continue as a going concern and the report regarding AICL which includes an explanatory paragraph regarding changes in accounting principles, the impact of the Korean economic situation on AICL and the ability of AICL to continue as a going concern. 77 79 GLOSSARY ASIC....................... Application Specific Integrated Circuit. A custom-designed integrated circuit that performs specific functions which would otherwise require a number of off-the-shelf integrated circuits to perform. The use of an ASIC in place of a conventional integrated circuit reduces product size and cost and also improves reliability. BGA........................ Ball grid array. Bus........................ A common pathway, or channel, between multiple devices. CMOS....................... Complementary Metal Oxide Silicon. Currently the most common integrated circuit fabrication process technology, CMOS is one of the latest fabrication techniques to use metal oxide semiconductor transistors. DAC........................ Digital Analog Converter. A device that converts digital pulses into analog signals. Die........................ A piece of a semiconductor wafer containing the circuitry of a single chip. DRAM....................... Dynamic Random Access Memory. A type of volatile memory product that is used in electronic systems to store data and program instructions. It is the most common type of RAM and must be refreshed with electricity thousands of times per second or else it will fade away. DSP........................ Digital Signal Processor. A type of integrated circuit that processes and manipulates digital information after it has been converted from an analog source. EEPROM..................... Electrically Erasable and Programmable Read-Only Memory. A form of non-volatile memory that can be erased electronically before being reprogrammed. EPROM...................... Erasable Programmable Read-Only Memory. A programmable and reusable chip that holds its content until erased under ultraviolet light. Ethernet................... A type of local area network (LAN). Most widely used LAN access method. Flash Memory............... A type of non-volatile memory, similar to an EEPROM in that it is erasable and reprogrammable. FlipChip................... Package type where silicon die is attached to the packaging substrate using solder balls instead of wires. See "Business -- Products." GPS........................ Global Positioning System. A system for identifying earth locations. GUI........................ Graphical User Interface. A graphics-based user interface that incorporates icons, pull-down menus and a mouse. IC......................... Integrated Circuit. A combination of two or more transistors on a base material, usually silicon. All semiconductor chips, including memory chips and logic chips, are just very complicated ICs with thousands of transistors. Input/Output............... A connector which interconnects the chip to the package or one package level to the next level in the hierarchy. Also referred to as pin out connections or terminals. ISDN....................... Integrated Services Digital Network. An international telecommunications standard for transmitting voice, video and data over digital lines running at 64 Kbps. Logic Device............... A device that contains digital integrated circuits that process, rather than store, information. 78 80 Mask....................... A piece of glass on which an IC's circuitry design is laid out. Integrated circuits may require up to 20 different layers of design, each with its own mask. In the IC production process, a light shines through the mask leaving an image of the design on the wafer. Also known as a reticle. MBGA....................... Micro Ball Grid Array. See "Business -- Products." Micron..................... 1/25,000 of an inch. Circuitry on an IC typically follows lines that are less than one micron wide. MOS........................ A device which consists of three layers (metal, oxide and semiconductors) and operates as a transistor. MQFP....................... Metric Quad Flat Package. See "Business -- Products." PBGA....................... Plastic Ball Grid Array. See "Business -- Products." PC......................... Personal Computer. PCMCIA..................... Standard for connecting peripherals to computers. PDA........................ Personal Digital Assistant. PDIP....................... Plastic Dual In-Line Packages. See "Business -- Products." Photolithography........... A lithographic technique used to transfer the design of the circuit paths and electronic elements on a chip onto a wafer's surface. PLCC....................... Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier. See "Business -- Products." PLD........................ A logic chip that is programmed at the customer's site. PQFP....................... Plastic Quad Flat Packages. See "Business -- Products." RF......................... Radio Frequency. The range of electromagnetic frequencies above the audio range and below visible light. SIP........................ Single In-Line Package. See "Business -- Products." SOIC....................... Small Outline IC Packages. See "Business -- Products." SRAM....................... Static Random Access Memory. A type of volatile memory product that is used in electronic systems to store data and program instructions. Unlike the more common DRAM, it does not need to be refreshed. SSOP....................... Shrink Small Outline Packages. See "Business -- Products." Surface Mount Technology... A circuit board packaging technique in which the leads (pins) on the chips and components are soldered on top of the board. TQFP....................... Thin Quad Flat Packages. See "Business -- Products." TSOP....................... Thin Small Outline Packages. See "Business -- Products." TSSOP...................... Thin Shrink Small Outline Packages. See "Business -- Products." Wafer...................... Thin, round, flat piece of silicon that is the base of most integrated circuits. Wire Bonding............... The method used to attach very fine wire to semiconductor components in order to provide electrical continuity between the semiconductor die and a terminal. 79 81 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. INDEX TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
PAGE ---- Report of Independent Public Accountants (Arthur Andersen LLP)...................................................... F-2 Combined Statements of Income -- Years ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and Three Months ended March 31, 1997 (unaudited) and 1998 (unaudited).......................... F-3 Combined Balance Sheets -- December 31, 1996 and 1997 and March 31, 1998 (unaudited)................................ F-4 Combined Statements of Stockholders' Equity -- Years ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and Three Months Ended March 31, 1998 (unaudited)................................ F-5 Combined Statements of Cash Flows -- Years ended December 31, 1995, 1996 and 1997 and Three Months ended March 31, 1997 (unaudited) and March 31, 1998 (unaudited)........... F-6 Notes to Combined Financial Statements...................... F-7 Independent Auditors' Report (Samil Accounting Corporation) with respect to Anam Industrial Co., Ltd.................. F-26 Independent Auditors' Report (Chong Un & Company) with respect to Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd....... F-28 Report of Independent Public Accountants (SyCip Gorres Velayo & Co) with respect to Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc.... F-29 Independent Auditors' Report (Siana Carr & O'Connor, LLP) with respect to Anam USA, Inc............................. F-30
F-1 82 REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS To Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc.: We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheets of Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc. and subsidiaries (see Note 1) as of December 31, 1996 and 1997, and the related combined statements of income, stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We did not audit the financial statements of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. ("AICL"), the investment in which is reflected in the accompanying financial statements using the equity method of accounting. The investment in AICL represents 4% and 2% of total assets at December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively, and the equity in its net income represents 5% of net income in 1995 and the equity in its net loss represents 4% and 29% of net income before the equity in income (loss) of AICL in 1996 and 1997, respectively. The statements of AICL were audited by other auditors whose report has been furnished to us and our opinion, insofar as it relates to amounts included for AICL, is based solely on the report of the other auditors. We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, based upon our audit and the report of other audits, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the combined financial position of Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1996 and 1997, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. The report of the other auditors referred to above indicates that the financial statements of AICL have been prepared assuming that AICL will continue as a going concern. The operations of AICL have been significantly affected, and will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by Korea's unstable economy caused by currency volatility and unstable finance markets in Korea. AICL has traditionally operated with a significant amount of debt relative to its equity and has a significant working capital deficit at December 31, 1997. Because of Korea's unstable economy and AICL's dependence on debt financing, there are significant uncertainties that may affect AICL's future operations and its abilities to maintain or refinance certain debt obligations as they mature, which raise substantial doubt regarding AICL's ability to continue as a going concern. The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot be determined presently and AICL's financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from these uncertainties. AICL's plans to address these matters are included in the notes to the AICL financial statements. ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP Philadelphia, Pa. February 3, 1998 (except with respect to the sale of the investment in Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. common stock discussed in Note 6, as to which the date is February 16, 1998, the Reorganization discussed in Note 16, as to which the date is April 29, 1998, and the Initial Public Offering discussed in Note 16, as to which the date is May 8, 1998). F-2 83 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. COMBINED STATEMENTS OF INCOME (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
FOR THE YEAR ENDED FOR THE THREE MONTHS DECEMBER 31, ENDED MARCH 31, ---------------------------------- ------------------------- 1995 1996 1997 1997 -------- ---------- ---------- ----------- 1998 (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) NET REVENUES............................. $932,382 $1,171,001 $1,455,761 $313,019 $371,733 COST OF REVENUES -- including purchases from AICL (Note 11).................... 783,335 1,022,078 1,242,669 287,449 310,056 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- GROSS PROFIT............................. 149,047 148,923 213,092 25,570 61,677 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- OPERATING EXPENSES: Selling, general and administrative.... 55,459 66,625 103,726 20,608 28,715 Research and development............... 8,733 10,930 8,525 1,485 2,057 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- Total operating expenses............ 64,192 77,555 112,251 22,093 30,772 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- OPERATING INCOME......................... 84,855 71,368 100,841 3,477 30,905 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- OTHER (INCOME) EXPENSE: Interest expense, net.................. 9,797 22,245 32,241 8,049 9,522 Foreign currency (gain) loss........... 1,512 2,961 (835) (1,490) 2,747 Other expense, net..................... 6,523 3,150 8,429 1,606 4,089 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- Total other expense................. 17,832 28,356 39,835 8,165 16,358 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES, EQUITY IN INCOME (LOSS) OF AICL AND MINORITY INTEREST............................... 67,023 43,012 61,006 (4,688) 14,547 PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES............... 6,384 7,876 7,078 (1,497) 5,050 EQUITY IN INCOME (LOSS) OF AICL.......... 2,808 (1,266) (17,291) -- -- MINORITY INTEREST........................ 1,515 948 (6,644) 1,638 685 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- NET INCOME............................... $ 61,932 $ 32,922 $ 43,281 $ (4,829) $ 8,812 ======== ========== ========== ======== ======== PRO FORMA DATA (UNAUDITED): Historical income before income taxes, equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest................... $ 67,023 $ 43,012 $ 61,006 $ (4,688) $ 14,547 Pro forma provision for income taxes... 16,784 10,776 10,691 62 4,222 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- Pro forma income before equity in income (loss) of AICL and minority interest............................ 50,239 32,236 50,315 (4,750) 10,325 Historical equity in income (loss) of AICL................................ 2,808 (1,266) (17,291) -- -- Historical minority interest........... 1,515 948 (6,644) 1,638 685 -------- ---------- ---------- -------- -------- Pro forma net income................... $ 51,532 $ 30,022 $ 39,668 $ (6,388) $ 9,640 ======== ========== ========== ======== ======== Basic and diluted pro forma net income per common share.................... $ .62 $ .36 $ .48 $ (.08) $ .12 ======== ========== ========== ======== ======== Shares used in computing pro forma net income per common share................ 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 82,610 ======== ========== ========== ======== ========
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements. F-3 84 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS (IN THOUSANDS)
DECEMBER 31, MARCH 31, 1998 -------------------- -------------------------- 1996 1997 ACTUAL PRO FORMA -------- -------- ----------- ----------- (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) ASSETS CURRENT ASSETS: Cash and cash equivalents................... $ 49,664 $ 90,917 $ 41,989 $ 6,289 Short-term investments...................... 881 2,524 2,952 2,952 Accounts receivable -- Trade, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $1,179, $4,234, $5,413 and $5,413................................. 170,892 102,804 103,390 103,390 Due from affiliates...................... 26,886 14,431 14,923 14,923 Other.................................... 6,426 4,879 10,222 10,222 Inventories................................. 101,920 115,870 93,465 93,465 Other current assets........................ 8,618 26,997 32,282 32,282 -------- -------- -------- -------- Total current assets................ 365,287 358,422 299,223 263,523 -------- -------- -------- -------- PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT, net............ 324,895 427,061 433,226 433,226 -------- -------- -------- -------- INVESTMENTS: AICL at equity.............................. 31,154 13,863 -- -- Other....................................... 38,090 5,958 5,290 5,290 -------- -------- -------- -------- Total investments................... 69,244 19,821 5,290 5,290 -------- -------- -------- -------- OTHER ASSETS: Due from affiliates......................... 20,699 29,186 24,348 24,348 Other....................................... 24,739 21,102 24,801 26,301 -------- -------- -------- -------- 45,438 50,288 49,149 50,649 -------- -------- -------- -------- Total assets........................ $804,864 $855,592 $786,888 752,688 ======== ======== ======== ======== LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY CURRENT LIABILITIES: Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt........................... $191,813 $167,317 $120,173 120,173 Trade accounts payable...................... 45,798 113,037 105,913 105,913 Due to affiliates........................... 33,379 15,581 28,653 28,653 Bank overdraft.............................. 14,518 29,765 21,087 21,087 Accrued expenses............................ 30,156 43,973 64,371 64,371 Accrued income taxes........................ 12,838 26,968 34,652 34,652 -------- -------- -------- -------- Total current liabilities........... 328,502 396,641 374,849 374,849 -------- -------- -------- -------- LONG-TERM DEBT................................ 167,444 196,934 197,859 197,859 -------- -------- -------- -------- DUE TO ANAM USA, INC. (Note 11)............... 234,894 149,776 88,280 88,280 -------- -------- -------- -------- OTHER NONCURRENT LIABILITIES.................. 12,286 12,084 15,582 15,582 -------- -------- -------- -------- COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Notes 1 and 13) MINORITY INTEREST............................. 15,926 9,282 9,968 9,968 -------- -------- -------- -------- STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY: Amkor Technology, Inc. -- common stock...... 45 45 45 45 AK Industries, Inc. -- common stock......... 1 1 1 1 Additional paid-in capital.................. 16,770 20,871 20,871 20,871 Retained earnings........................... 32,340 70,621 79,433 45,233 Unrealized losses on investments............ (1,586) -- -- -- Cumulative translation adjustment........... (1,758) (663) -- -- -------- -------- -------- -------- Total stockholders' equity.......... 45,812 90,875 100,350 66,150 -------- -------- -------- -------- Total liabilities and stockholders' equity............................ $804,864 $855,592 $786,888 752,688 ======== ======== ======== ========
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements. F-4 85 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. COMBINED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1996, AND 1997 AND THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1998 (IN THOUSANDS)
AMKOR AK UNREALIZED TECHNOLOY, INDUSTRIES, GAINS INC. INC. ADDITIONAL (LOSSES) CUMULATIVE COMMON COMMON PAID-IN RETAINED ON TRANSLATION STOCK STOCK CAPITAL EARNINGS INVESTMENTS ADJUSTMENT TOTAL ---------- ----------- ---------- --------- ----------- ------------ --------- BALANCE AT JANUARY 1, 1995.... $45 $ 1 $16,494 $ (6,359) $ (35) $ (529) $ 9,617 Net income.................. -- -- -- 61,932 -- -- 61,932 Distributions............... -- -- -- (19,922) -- -- (19,922) Change in division equity account................... -- -- -- (4,505) -- -- (4,505) Unrealized gains (losses) on investments............... -- -- -- -- (2,015) -- (2,015) Currency translation adjustments............... -- -- -- -- -- 182 182 --- --- ------- -------- ------- ------- --------- BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1995........................ 45 1 16,494 31,146 (2,050) (347) 45,289 Net income.................. -- -- -- 32,922 -- -- 32,922 Distributions............... -- -- -- (15,123) -- -- (15,123) Change in division equity account................... -- -- -- (16,605) -- -- (16,605) Unrealized gains (losses) on investments............... -- -- -- -- 464 -- 464 Currency translation adjustments............... -- -- -- -- -- (1,411) (1,411) Acquisition of AATS (Note 14)....................... -- -- 276 -- -- -- 276 --- --- ------- -------- ------- ------- --------- BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1996........................ 45 1 16,770 32,340 (1,586) (1,758) 45,812 Net income.................. -- -- -- 43,281 -- -- 43,281 Distributions............... -- -- -- (5,000) -- -- (5,000) Change in division equity account................... -- -- 4,101 -- -- -- 4,101 Unrealized gains (losses) on investments............... -- -- -- -- 1,586 -- 1,586 Currency translation adjustments............... -- -- -- -- -- 1,095 1,095 --- --- ------- -------- ------- ------- --------- BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 1997........................ $45 $ 1 $20,871 $ 70,621 $ 0 $ (663) $ 90,875 Net income (unaudited) -- -- -- 8,812 -- -- 8,812 Currency translation adjustments (unaudited) -- -- -- -- -- 663 663 --- --- ------- -------- ------- ------- --------- BALANCE AT MARCH 31, 1998 (unaudited) $45 $ 1 $20,871 $ 79,433 $ 0 $ 0 $ 100,350 === === ======= ======== ======= ======= =========
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements. F-5 86 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (IN THOUSANDS)
FOR THE YEAR ENDED FOR THE THREE MONTHS DECEMBER 31, ENDED MARCH 31, ----------------------------------------- -------------------------- 1995 1996 1997 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- 1998 (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES: Net income..................................... $ 61,932 $ 32,922 $ 43,281 (4,829) 8,812 Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities -- Depreciation and amortization................ 26,614 57,825 81,864 19,622 27,139 Provision for accounts receivable............ 444 1,271 3,490 150 1,180 Provision for excess and obsolete inventory.................................. 1,000 500 12,659 1,850 7,200 Deferred income taxes........................ (1,147) (324) (11,715) 30 (3,419) Equity (gain) loss of investees.............. (2,713) 605 16,779 (540) -- (Gain) loss on sale of investments........... 126 (139) (239) -- 1,033 Minority interest............................ 1,515 948 (6,644) 1,637 686 Changes in assets and liabilities excluding effects of acquisitions -- Accounts receivable.......................... (53,264) (36,695) (19,802) 5,861 (566) Proceeds from sale/(repurchase of) accounts receivable................................. -- -- 90,700 -- (11,000) Other receivables............................ (2,565) (925) 1,547 (373) (1,843) Inventories.................................. (32,668) (16,380) (26,609) (11,608) 15,205 Due to/from affiliates, net.................. (3,001) (8,203) (19,138) (17,212) 17,418 Other current assets......................... (4,764) 1,694 (7,239) (3,860) 1,609 Other non-current assets..................... (326) (6,108) 3,322 (4,456) (3,745) Accounts payable............................. 35,017 (16,852) 60,939 53,421 (824) Accrued expenses............................. 17,687 (12,658) 13,817 (1,163) 20,398 Accrued taxes................................ 404 7,433 14,130 (2,117) 7,684 Other long-term liabilities.................. 9,034 (108) (1,089) 520 23 Other, net................................... -- 3,750 -- -- -- ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- Net cash provided by operating activities............................. 53,325 8,556 250,053 36,933 86,990 ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES: Purchases of property, plant and equipment, including purchase of AATS................... (123,645) (185,112) (178,990) (67,072) (33,685) Sale of property, plant and equipment.......... 110 2,228 1,413 -- 57 Purchases of investments and issuances of notes receivable................................... (25,123) (15,633) (15,187) (3,900) (428) Proceeds from sale of investments.............. 351 520 -- -- 668 ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- Net cash used in investing activities.... (148,307) (197,997) (192,764) (70,972) (33,388) ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES: Net change in bank overdrafts and short-term borrowings................................... 41,308 64,852 52,393 22,252 (47,410) Proceeds from issuance of Anam USA, Inc. debt......................................... 1,059,759 1,205,174 1,408,086 298,940 382,042 Payments of Anam USA, Inc. debt................ (1,052,415) (1,189,317) (1,443,464) (279,056) (429,675) Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt....... 50,080 102,193 11,389 -- 3,358 Payments of long-term debt..................... (3,021) (3,138) (43,541) (159) (10,845) Distributions to stockholders.................. (20,003) (15,205) (5,000) -- -- Change in division equity account.............. (4,505) (16,605) 4,101 3,651 -- ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities............................. 71,203 147,954 (16,036) 45,628 (102,530) ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS.................................... (23,779) (41,487) 41,253 11,589 (48,928) CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF PERIOD... 114,930 91,151 49,664 49,664 90,917 ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- --------- CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF PERIOD......... $ 91,151 $ 49,664 $ 90,917 61,253 41,989 =========== =========== =========== ========= ========= SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION: Cash paid during the period for: Interest..................................... $ 12,594 $ 24,125 $ 37,070 $ 9,589 10,392 Income taxes................................. 495 2,256 3,022 9 310
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements. F-6 87 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES Principles of Combination The combined financial statements of Amkor Technology, Inc. ("ATI") and its subsidiaries and AK Industries, Inc. and its subsidiary ("Amkor" or the "Company") include the accounts of the following (these companies are referred to as the "Amkor Companies"): - Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI"), a U.S. S Corporation and its wholly owned subsidiaries Amkor Receivables Corp and Amkor Wafer Fabrication Services SARL (a French Limited Company). - T.L. Limited ("TLL") (a British Cayman Island Corporation) and its Philippine subsidiaries, Amkor Anam Advanced Packaging, Inc. ("AAAP") (wholly owned) and Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. ("AAP") (which is currently owned 60% by TLL and 40% by Anam Semiconductor Inc. which changed its name in 1998 from Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. ("AICL"-- see Notes 11 and 16) and its wholly-owned subsidiary Automated MicroElectronics, Inc. ("AMI"); - C.I.L., Limited ("CIL") (a British Cayman Islands Corporation) and its wholly-owned subsidiary Amkor/Anam Euroservices S.A.R.L. ("AAES") (a French Corporation); - Amkor Anam Test Services, Inc. (a U.S. Corporation) (see Note 14); and - The semiconductor packaging and test business unit of Chamterry Enterprises, Ltd. ("Chamterry"). During the third quarter of 1997 Chamterry transferred its customers to AEI and CIL and ceased operations of its semiconductor and test business unit. - AK Industries, Inc. ("AKI") (a U.S. Corporation) and its wholly-owned subsidiary, Amkor-Anam, Inc. (a U.S. Corporation); All of the Amkor Companies are substantially wholly owned by Mr. and Mrs. James Kim or entities controlled by members of Mr. James Kim's immediate family (the "Founding Stockholders"), except for AAP which is 40% owned by AICL and one third of AEI and all of AKI which are owned by trusts established for the benefit of other members of Mr. James Kim's family ("Kim Family Trusts"). The Amkor Companies are an interdependent group of companies involved in the same business under the direction of common management. ATI was formed in September 1997 to facilitate the Reorganization and consolidate the ownership of the Amkor Companies. In connection with the Reorganization, AEI was merged into ATI. Amkor International Holdings ("AIH") a newly formed Cayman Islands holding company became a wholly owned subsidiary of ATI. AIH holds the following entities: First Amkor Caymans, Inc. ("FACI"), a newly formed holding company, and its subsidiaries AAAP and AAP and AAP's subsidiary AMI, TLL and its subsidiary CIL and CIL's subsidiary AAES. The relative number of shares of common stock issued by the Company in connection with each of the transactions comprising the Reorganization was based upon the relative amounts of stockholders' equity at December 31, 1997. In exchange for their interests in AEI, Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts received two-thirds (9,746,760 shares) and one-third (4,873,380 shares) of the ATI common stock then outstanding, respectively. ATI then issued 67,989,851 shares of common stock, representing approximately 82% of its shares immediately after the Reorganization, in exchange for all of the outstanding shares of AIH and its subsidiaries. Of such shares, 27,528,234 shares and, 36,376,617 shares were gifted to Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts, respectively, such that Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts own 45.1% and 49.9%, respectively, of the ATI common shares outstanding after the Reorganization. Following such transactions the Founding Stockholders beneficially owned a majority of the outstanding shares of ATI common stock. In addition, ATI acquired all of the stock of AKI from the Kim Family Trusts for $3,000. The merger of AEI and ATI, the creation of AIH and FACI, the issuance of ATI common stock for AIH and the acquisition of AKI are collectively referred to as the Reorganization. F-7 88 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) Included within the Amkor Companies following the Reorganization are ATI, AIH and its subsidiaries and AKI and its subsidiary. All of the subsidiaries are wholly owned except for 40% of the common stock of AAP which is owned by AICL (see Note 16), and a small number of shares of each of AAP, AAAP and AMI which are required to be owned by directors of these companies pursuant to Philippine law. Except for the acquisition of the shares of AKI which has been accounted for as a purchase transaction, the Reorganization described above was treated similar to a pooling of interests as it represents an exchange of equity interests among companies under common control. The purchase price for the AKI stock, which represents the fair value of these shares, approximates the book value of AKI. The financial statements are presented on a combined basis as a result of the common ownership and business operations of all of the Amkor Companies, including AKI. As a result of the acquisition of AKI, AKI became a wholly owned subsidiary of ATI; accordingly, future financial statements will be presented for ATI and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis. The financial statements reflect the elimination of all significant intercompany accounts and transactions. The investments in and the operating results of 20%- to 50%-owned companies are included in the combined financial statements using the equity method of accounting. Basis of Presentation The accompanying financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis which contemplates realization of assets and liquidation of liabilities in the ordinary course of business. At December 31, 1997 the Company was not in compliance with certain restrictive covenants of its principal long-term debt agreements and, as a result, amounts due under these agreements were previously classified as current liabilities in the combined balance sheet. The Company had not received any notification that the Company's repayment obligations with respect to these loans had been accelerated as a result of such covenant violations. However, there was no assurance that the Company could generate sufficient cash flow from operations or other sources to satisfy these liabilities should they become due before maturity. Consequently, the report of the Company's independent public accountants included a paragraph stating that there was a substantial doubt as to the ability of the Company to continue as a going concern. As a result of the Initial Public Offering (see Note 16), the Company used part of the net proceeds to repay these bank loans and the paragraph discussed above has been removed from the report of the independent public accountants. Nature of Operations The Company provides semiconductor packaging and test services to semiconductor and computer manufacturers located in strategic markets throughout the world. Such services are provided by the Company and by AICL under a long-standing arrangement. Approximately 79%, 72% and 68% of the Company's packaging and test revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997 respectively, relate to the packaging and test services provided by AICL. Concentrations of Credit Risk Financial instruments, for which the Company is subject to credit risk, consist principally of trade receivables. The Company has mitigated this risk by selling primarily to well established companies, performing ongoing credit evaluations and making frequent contact with customers. At December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company maintained $34,330 and $53,071, respectively, in deposits at one U.S. financial institution and $1,861 and $2,548, respectively, in deposits at U.S. banks which exceeded federally insured limits. F-8 89 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) Additionally, at December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company maintained deposits and certificates of deposits totaling approximately $14,649 and $34,622, respectively, at foreign owned banks. Significant Customers The Company has a number of major customers in North America, Asia and Europe. The Company's largest customer, Intel Corporation, accounted for approximately 13.3%, 23.5% and 23.4% of net revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company's five largest customers collectively accounted for 34.1%, 39.2% and 40.1% of net revenues in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company anticipates that significant customer concentration will continue for the foreseeable future, although the companies which constitute the Company's largest customers may change. Risks and Uncertainties The Company's future results of operations involve a number of risks and uncertainties. Factors that could affect the Company's future operating results and cause actual results to vary materially from expectations include, but are not limited to, dependence on the highly cyclical nature of both the semiconductor and the personal computer industries, competitive pricing and declines in average selling prices, dependence on the Company's relationship with AICL (see Note 11), reliance on a small group of principal customers, timing and volume of orders relative to the Company's production capacity, availability of manufacturing capacity and fluctuations in manufacturing yields, availability of financing, competition, dependence on international operations and sales, dependence on raw material and equipment suppliers, exchange rate fluctuations, dependence on key personnel, difficulties in managing growth, enforcement of intellectual property rights, environmental regulations and fluctuations in quarterly operating results. Foreign Currency Translation Substantially all of the Company's foreign subsidiaries use the U.S. dollar as their functional currency. Accordingly, monetary assets and liabilities which were originally denominated in a foreign currency are translated into U.S. dollars at month-end exchange rates. Non-monetary items which were originally denominated in foreign currencies are translated at historical rates. Gains and losses from such transactions and from transactions denominated in foreign currencies are included in other (income) expense, net. The cumulative translation adjustment reflected in stockholders' equity in the combined balance sheets relates primarily to investments in unconsolidated companies which use the local currency as the functional currency (see Note 6). Cash and Cash Equivalents The Company considers all highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents. Accounts Receivable At December 31, 1997, trade accounts receivable represent the Company's interest in receivables sold in excess of amounts purchased by banks under an accounts receivable sale agreement (see Note 2). Of the total net trade accounts receivable amount at December 31, 1997, $19,905 relates to the trade accounts receivable of CIL which were not sold under the Agreement. Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined principally by using a moving average method. F-9 90 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) Property, Plant and Equipment Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is calculated by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of depreciable assets. Accelerated methods are used for tax purposes. Depreciable lives follow: Building and improvements............................. 10 to 30 years Machinery and equipment............................... 3 to 5 years Furniture, fixtures, and other equipment.............. 3 to 10 years
Cost and accumulated depreciation for property retired or disposed of are removed from the accounts and any resulting gain or loss is included in earnings. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred. Depreciation expense was $27,381, $58,497 and $81,159 for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. Other Noncurrent Assets Other noncurrent assets consist principally of security deposits, deferred income taxes and the cash surrender value of life insurance policies. Other Noncurrent Liabilities Other noncurrent liabilities consist primarily of pension obligations and noncurrent income taxes payable. Income Taxes The Company accounts for income taxes following the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes," which requires the use of the liability method. If it is more likely than not that some portion or all of a deferred tax asset will not be realized, a valuation allowance is provided. The Company reports certain income and expense items for income tax purposes on a basis different from that reflected in the accompanying combined financial statements. The principal differences relate to the timing of the recognition of accrued expenses which are not deductible for federal income tax purposes until paid, the use of accelerated methods of depreciation for income tax purposes and unrecognized foreign exchange gains and losses. AEI elected to be taxed as an S Corporation under the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and comparable state tax provisions. As a result, AEI does not recognize U.S. federal corporate income taxes. Instead, the stockholders of AEI are taxed on their proportionate share of AEI's taxable income. Accordingly, no provision for U.S. federal income taxes was recorded for AEI. Given the pending Offerings (see Note 16), for informational purposes, the accompanying combined statements of income include an unaudited pro forma adjustment to reflect income taxes which would have been recorded if AEI had not been an S Corporation, based on the tax laws in effect during the respective periods (see Note 17). Subsequent to March 31, 1998, AEI terminated its S Corporation Status. Effective May 1, 1998, the profits of AEI will be subject to federal and state income taxes at the corporate level. Earnings Per Share The pro forma net income per common share was calculated by dividing the pro forma net income by the weighted average number of shares outstanding for the respective periods, adjusted for the effect of the Reorganization (see Note 16). F-10 91 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) In the fourth quarter of 1997, the Company adopted SFAS No. 128, "Earnings Per Share," which requires dual presentation of basic and diluted earnings per share on the face of the income statement. Basic EPS is computed using only the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period while diluted EPS is computed assuming conversion of all dilutive securities, such as options. In accordance with the statement, all prior period per share amounts have been revised to reflect the new presentation. The Company's basic and diluted per share amounts are the same for all periods presented. There have been no changes to historical per share amounts. Revenue Recognition and Risk of Loss The Company records revenues upon shipment of packaged semiconductors to its customers. The Company does not take ownership of customer-supplied semiconductors. Title and risk of loss remains with the customer for these materials at all times. Risk of loss for Amkor packaging costs passes upon completion of the packaging process and shipment to the customer. Accordingly, the cost of the customer-supplied materials is not included in the combined statements of income. Research and Development Costs Research and development costs are charged to expense as incurred. Use of Estimates in the Preparation of Financial Statements The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Recently Issued Accounting Standards In June 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued SFAS No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income." This statement establishes standards for reporting and display of income and its components in financial statements. The Company will be required to adopt this statement in 1998. In June 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 131, "Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information." Under this statement, reporting standards were established for the way that public business enterprises report information about operating segments in annual financial statements and selected information about operating segments in interim financial reports issued to shareholders. Generally, financial information is required to be reported on the basis that it is used internally for evaluating segment performance and deciding how to allocate resources to segments. This statement is effective for financial statements for periods beginning after December 15, 1997. In the initial year of application, comparative information for earlier years presented is to be restated. This statement need not be applied to interim financial statements in the initial year of its application, but comparative information for interim periods in the initial year of application is to be reported in financial statements for interim periods in the second year of application. The Company will adopt this statement prospectively for the year ended December 31, 1998. Interim Financial Statements The financial statements and related disclosures for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1998 are unaudited and, in the opinion of management of the Company, include all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments) necessary for the fair presentation of the results for the interim period. The F-11 92 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) results of operations for the three months ended March 31, 1998 are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the full year. Reclassifications Certain previously reported amounts have been reclassified to conform with the current presentation. 2. ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE SALE AGREEMENT Effective July 7, 1997, the Company entered into an agreement to sell receivables (the "Agreement") with certain banks (the "Purchasers"). The transaction qualifies as a sale under the provisions of SFAS No. 125 "Accounting For Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities." Under the Agreement, the Purchasers have committed to purchase, with limited recourse, all right, title and interest in selected accounts receivable of the Company, up to a maximum of $100,000. In connection with the Agreement, the Company established a wholly owned, bankruptcy remote subsidiary, Amkor Receivables Corp., to purchase accounts receivable at a discount from the Company on a continuous basis, subject to certain limitations as described in the Agreement. Amkor Receivables Corp. simultaneously sells the accounts receivable at the same discount to the Purchasers. AICL has guaranteed AEI's obligations under the Agreement (see Note 11). The Agreement is structured as a three year facility subject to annual renewals based upon the mutual consent of the Company and purchasers. The first such renewal date is June 18, 1998. The Company and AICL did not comply with certain financial covenants under the Agreement as of December 31, 1997. The Purchasers have agreed to waive compliance with these covenants through January 2, 1999. The Company applied approximately $83.4 million of the Receivables Sale proceeds together with approximately $17 million of working capital to reduce the Company's indebtedness to AUSA which amounts were advanced by AUSA to entities controlled by members of James Kim's family. Proceeds from the sale of receivables were $84,400 in 1997. Losses on receivables sold under the Agreement were approximately $2,414 in 1997 and are included in other expense, net. As of December 31, 1997, approximately $6,300 is included in current liabilities for amounts to be refunded to the Purchasers as a result of a reduction in selected accounts receivable. 3. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT Property, plant and equipment consist of the following:
DECEMBER 31, ------------------- MARCH 31, 1996 1997 1998 -------- -------- ----------- (UNAUDITED) Land................................. $ -- $ 2,346 2,346 Building and improvements............ 81,602 109,528 123,854 Machinery and equipment.............. 333,188 448,032 473,082 Furniture, fixtures and other equipment.......................... 31,330 33,050 35,109 Construction in progress............. 5,240 31,964 22,548 -------- -------- -------- 451,360 624,920 656,939 Less -- Accumulated depreciation and amortization....................... 126,465 197,859 223,713 -------- -------- -------- $324,895 $427,061 433,226 ======== ======== ========
4. COMMON STOCK AND ADDITIONAL PAID-IN CAPITAL The common stock and additional paid-in-capital of the Company are reflected at the original cost of the Amkor Companies. In connection with the Reorganization, the Company authorized 500,000,000 shares of F-12 93 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) $.001 par value common stock, of which 82,610,000 shares were issued to the stockholders of the Amkor Companies in exchange for their interests in these Companies. In addition, the Company authorized 10,000,000 shares of $.001 par value preferred stock, designated as Series A. Changes in the division equity account reflected in the combined statement of stockholders' equity represent the net cash flows resulting from the operations of the Chamterry semiconductor packaging and test business for the periods indicated. Such cash flows have been presented as distributions or capital contributions since these amounts were retained in Chamterry Enterprises, Ltd. for the benefit of the owners. 5. INVENTORIES Inventories consist of raw materials and purchased components which are used in the semiconductor packaging process. The Company's inventories are located at its facilities in the Philippines or at AICL on a consignment basis. Components of inventories follow:
DECEMBER 31, ------------------- MARCH 31, 1996 1997 1998 -------- -------- ----------- (UNAUDITED) Raw materials and purchased components......................... $ 93,112 $105,748 84,543 Work-in-process...................... 8,808 10,122 8,922 -------- -------- -------- $101,920 $115,870 93,465 ======== ======== ========
6. INVESTMENTS The Company's investments include investments in affiliated companies which provide services to the Company (see Note 11) and certain other technology based companies. Investments are summarized as follows:
DECEMBER 31, ------------------ 1996 1997 ------- ------- Equity Investment in AICL (10.2% and 8.1% at December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively)...... $31,154 $13,863 ------- ------- Other Equity Investments (20%-50% owned) Anam Semiconductor & Technology Co., Ltd....... 10,700 -- Datacom International, Inc..................... 1,335 -- Sunrise Capital Fund........................... 1,328 -- Other.......................................... 1,373 738 ------- ------- Total other equity investments......... 14,736 738 ------- ------- Available for Sale (cost based investments)...... 23,354 5,220 ------- ------- $69,244 $19,821 ======= =======
The Company had net unamortized investment costs in excess of the proportionate share of the investee companies' net assets of approximately $1,284 and $0 at December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively. On August 1, 1997, the Company sold its equity investment in Anam Semiconductor & Technology Co., Ltd. ("Anam S&T") and certain investments and notes receivable from companies unrelated to the semiconductor packaging and test business to AK Investments, Inc., an entity owned by James J. Kim, at cost ($49,740) and AK Investments, Inc. assumed $49,740 of the Company's long-term borrowings from Anam USA, Inc. Management estimates that the fair value of these investments and notes receivable approximated the carrying value at August 1, 1997. Subsequent to the sale on August 1, 1997 the Company loaned AK F-13 94 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) Investments, Inc. $12,800 for the purchase of additional investments. The amount outstanding on this loan at December 31, 1997 was $4,350. The Company's investment in AICL is accounted for using the equity method of accounting. Although the Company does not own in excess of 20% of the outstanding common stock of AICL, the Company through its common ownership with the Kim family and entities controlled by the Kim family owns 40.7% of the outstanding common stock of AICL and may exercise a significant influence over AICL. Accordingly the Company applies the equity method based on its ownership interest. A significant portion of the shares owned by the Kim family are leveraged and as a result of this, or for other reasons, the family's ownership could be substantially reduced. In 1997, the Company recognized a loss of $17,291, resulting principally from the impairment of value of its investment in AICL as well as the current year equity in income (loss) of AICL. The amount of the loss was determined based upon the market value of the AICL shares on the Korean Stock Exchange on February 16, 1998, the date that the Company sold its investment in AICL common stock to AK Investments, Inc. In exchange for the shares, AK Investments, Inc. assumed $13,863 of the Company's long-term borrowings from Anam USA, Inc. The Company is advised that AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 1997. The Korean economy is undergoing changes as evidenced by the agreement between the Korean government and the International Monetary Fund. Among other things, this agreement includes a restructuring plan of the banking industry as a whole which will most likely have a material effect on AICL's operations. The overall impact of these economic changes on AICL is uncertain at this time. AICL's independent auditors' report indicates that the financial statements of AICL have been prepared assuming that AICL will continue as a going concern. The operations of AICL have been significantly affected, and will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by Korea's unstable economy caused by currency volatility and unstable finance markets in Korea. AICL has traditionally operated with a significant amount of debt relative to its equity and has a significant working capital deficit at December 31, 1997. Because of Korea's unstable economy and AICL's dependence on debt financing, the report indicates that there are significant uncertainties that may affect AICL's future operations and its abilities to maintain or refinance certain debt obligations as they mature, which raise substantial doubt regarding AICL's ability to continue as a going concern. The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot be determined presently and AICL's financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from these uncertainties. AICL's plans to address these matters are included in the notes to the AICL's financial statements. AICL's financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP, which differs from U.S. GAAP in certain significant respects. The Company's equity in income (loss) of AICL is based upon the Korean GAAP information noted above and the Company's estimate of significant U.S. GAAP adjustments. These adjustments were not significant in 1995 and 1996. In 1997, AICL recognized a W349 billion loss principally as a result of foreign exchange losses on U.S. dollar denominated liabilities due to the significant depreciation of the won relative to the U.S. dollar. For purposes of determining the Company's equity in income (loss) of AICL under U.S. GAAP, losses on remeasuring U.S. dollar denominated liabilities are not recognized as the U.S. dollar is the functional currency for AICL. Such U.S. dollar denominated liabilities were W2,144 billion at December 31, 1997. Also, at December 31, 1997, the carrying value of the investment in AICL, adjusted for the loss on the 1998 disposition discussed above, is less than the Company's portion of AICL's net assets after consideration of the estimated U.S. GAAP adjustments. The most significant such adjustment affecting net assets is the remeasurement of property, plant and equipment to historical costs as required as the U.S. dollar is the functional currency. F-14 95 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) The following summary of consolidated financial information pertaining to AICL was derived from the consolidated financial statements referred to above. All amounts are in millions of Korean Won:
1995 1996 1997 ---------- ---------- ---------- SUMMARY INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION: Sales........................................ W1,105,273 W1,338,718 W1,786,457 Net income (loss)............................ 18,333 (9,385) (348,729) SUMMARY BALANCE SHEET INFORMATION: Total assets................................. 2,225,288 3,936,030 Total liabilities............................ 1,975,431 3,834,096
7. SHORT-TERM CREDIT FACILITIES At December 31, 1996 and 1997, short-term borrowings consisted of various operating lines of credit and working capital facilities maintained by the Company. These borrowings are secured by receivables, inventories or property. These facilities, which are typically for one-year renewable terms, generally bear interest at current market rates appropriate for the country in which the borrowing is made (ranging from 7.2% to 13.0% at December 31, 1997). For 1996 and 1997, the weighted average interest rate on these borrowings was 7.8% and 8.6%, respectively. Included in cash and cash equivalents is $1,200 of certificates of deposit pledged as collateral for certain of these lines. The unused portion of lines of credit total $36,169 at December 31, 1997. F-15 96 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) 8. DEBT Following is a summary of the Company's short-term borrowings and long-term debt:
DECEMBER 31, ---------------------- 1996 1997 --------- --------- Short-term borrowings (see Note 7).......................... $ 150,513 $ 187,659 Bank loan, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (6.78% at December 31, 1997), due October, 2000..................... 50,000 50,000 Bank loan, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (6.68% at December 31, 1997), due in installments beginning March, 1998 through April, 2001.................................. 71,250 71,250 Floating rate notes (FRNs), interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (7.38% at August 20, 1997, date of redemption)..... 40,000 -- Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (9.37% at December 31, 1997), due December, 2001.................... 20,000 20,000 Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (12.22% at December 31, 1997,) due October, 1998..................... 5,000 5,000 Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (9.09% at December 31, 1997), due in installments with balance due September, 1999........................................... 4,000 3,500 Bank debt, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (11.88% at December 31, 1997), due in equal installments through January, 2001............................................. 5,926 5,502 Note payable, interest at prime (8.50% at December 31, 1997), due in semiannual installments beginning November 1999 through April, 2004.................................. -- 9,530 Note payable, interest at LIBOR plus annual spread (12.48% at December 31, 1997), due in installments with balance due November, 1999........................................ 11,000 9,000 Other, primarily capital lease obligations and other debt... 1,568 2,810 --------- --------- 359,257 364,251 Less -- Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt............................................ (191,813) (167,317) --------- --------- $ 167,444 $ 196,934 ========= =========
The Bank loans were obtained to finance the expansion of the Company's factories in the Philippines. The Company has the option to prepay all or part of the loans on any interest payment date. These Bank loans are unconditionally and irrevocably guaranteed by AICL. The Bank loans contain provisions pertaining to the maintenance of specified debt-to-equity ratios, restrictions with respect to corporate reorganization, acquisition of capital stock or substantially all of the assets of any other corporations and advances and dispositions of all or a substantial portion of the borrower's assets, except in the ordinary course of business. AAP has not been in compliance with covenants regarding the maintenance of certain debt-to-equity ratios and advances to affiliates. As a result of the receipt of the net proceeds from the Initial Public Offering (see Note 16), amounts due under these agreements and certain other agreements with cross-default clauses have been classified as non-current liabilities in the accompanying combined balance sheet. Other bank debt instruments have interest rates based on Singapore interbank rates and LIBOR plus an annual spread. The loans are secured by assets of the Company and assets acquired through proceeds from the loans. F-16 97 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) Principal payments required under long-term debt borrowings at December 31, 1997 are as follows:
AMOUNT -------- 1998.............................................. $138,309 1999.............................................. 9,153 2000.............................................. 2,360 2001.............................................. 22,003 2002.............................................. 1,905 Thereafter........................................ 2,862 -------- Total............................................. $176,592 ========
9. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS U.S. Pension Plans AEI has a defined contribution benefit plan covering substantially all U.S. employees under which AEI matches 75% of the employee's contributions of between 6% and 10% of salary, up to a defined maximum on an annual basis. The pension expense for this plan was $483, $776 and $959 in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The pension plan assets are invested primarily in equity and fixed income securities. Philippine Pension Plans AAAP, AAP and AMI sponsor several defined benefit plans that cover substantially all employees who are not covered by statutory plans. Charges to expense are based upon costs computed by independent actuaries. The components of net periodic pension cost for the defined benefit plans are as follows:
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, -------------------------- 1995 1996 1997 ------ ------ ------ Service cost of current period................... $ 974 $1,542 $1,274 Interest cost on projected benefit obligation.... 811 1,228 957 Actual return on plan assets..................... (609) (677) (585) Net amortization and deferrals................... 100 98 132 ------ ------ ------ Total pension expense.................. $1,276 $2,191 $1,778 ====== ====== ======
It is the Company's policy to make contributions sufficient to meet the minimum contributions required by law and regulation. F-17 98 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) The following table sets forth the funded status and the amounts recognized in the combined balance sheets for the defined benefit pension plans:
1996 1997 ------- ------- Actuarial present value of: Vested benefit obligation.............................. $ 1,696 $ 1,546 ======= ======= Accumulated benefit obligation......................... $ 2,848 $ 2,669 ======= ======= Actuarial present value of projected benefit obligation............................................. $12,699 10,428 Plan assets at fair value................................ 6,077 6,614 ------- ------- Plan assets less than projected benefit obligation....... (6,622) (3,814) Prior service cost....................................... 1,125 967 Unrecognized net loss.................................... 1,800 953 ------- ------- Accrued pension cost..................................... $(3,697) $(1,894) ======= =======
The weighted average interest rate used in determining the projected benefit obligation was 12% as of December 31, 1996 and 1997. The rates of increase in future compensation levels was 11% as of December 31, 1996 and 1997. The expected long-term rate of return on plan assets was 12% as of December 31, 1996 and 1997. 10. INCOME TAXES The provision for income taxes includes federal, state and foreign taxes currently payable and those deferred because of temporary differences between the financial statement and the tax bases of assets and liabilities. The components of the provision for income taxes follow:
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, --------------------------------- 1995 1996 1997 -------- -------- --------- Current: Federal....................................... $6,125 $5,880 $16,126 State......................................... 908 60 2,639 Foreign....................................... 498 2,260 28 ------ ------ ------- 7,531 8,200 18,793 ------ ------ ------- Deferred: Federal....................................... (173) (226) (4,991) Foreign....................................... (974) (98) (6,724) ------ ------ ------- (1,147) (324) (11,715) ------ ------ ------- Total provision....................... $6,384 $7,876 $ 7,078 ====== ====== =======
F-18 99 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) The reconciliation between the tax payable based upon the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate and the recorded provision follow:
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, ------------------------------- 1995 1996 1997 -------- ------- -------- Federal statutory rate...................... $ 23,458 $15,054 $ 21,352 State taxes, net of federal benefit......... 908 60 1,285 S Corp. status of AEI....................... (10,400) (2,900) (3,613) (Income) losses of foreign subsidiaries subject to tax holiday.................... -- 4,957 (5,106) Foreign exchange losses recognized for income taxes.............................. (1,649) -- (21,147) Valuation allowance......................... 22,000 Difference in rates on foreign subsidiaries.............................. (5,933) (9,295) (7,693) -------- ------- -------- Total............................. $ 6,384 $ 7,876 $ 7,078 ======== ======= ========
The Company has structured its global operations to take advantage of lower tax rates in certain countries and tax incentives extended to encourage investment. AAP had a tax holiday in the Philippines which expired in 1995. AAAP has a tax holiday in the Philippines which expires at the end of 2002. Foreign exchange losses recognized for income taxes relate to unrecognized net foreign exchange losses on U.S. dollar denominated monetary assets and liabilities. These losses, which are not recognized for financial reporting purposes as the U.S. dollar is the functional currency (see Note 1), result in deferred tax assets that will be realized, for Philippine tax reporting purposes, upon settlement of the related asset or liability. The deferred tax asset related to these losses increased in 1997 as a result of the dramatic devaluation of the Philippine peso relative to the U.S. dollar. The Company's ability to utilize these assets depends on the timing of the settlement of the related assets or liabilities and the amount of taxable income recognized within the Philippine statutory carryforward limit of three years. Accordingly, a valuation allowance has been established in 1997 for a portion of the related deferred tax assets. The following is a summary of the significant components of the Company's deferred tax assets and liabilities:
DECEMBER 31, ------------------ 1996 1997 ------ -------- Deferred tax assets (liabilities): Retirement benefits.................................... $ 888 $ 816 Receivables............................................ 344 227 Inventories............................................ 1,057 6,509 Unrealized foreign exchange losses..................... 398 37,447 Unrealized foreign exchange gains...................... (614) (9,084) Other.................................................. 225 98 ------ -------- Net deferred tax asset................................. 2,298 36,013 Valuation allowance.................................... -- (22,000) ------ -------- Net deferred tax asset................................. $2,298 $ 14,013 ====== ========
Non-U.S. income before taxes and minority interest of the Company was $23,800, $20,420 and $32,920 in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. F-19 100 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) At December 31, 1996 and 1997 current deferred tax assets of $1,919 and $13,439, respectively, are included in other current assets and noncurrent deferred tax assets of $379 and $574, respectively, are included in other assets in the combined balance sheet. The Company's net deferred tax assets include amounts which management believes are realizable through future taxable income. The Company's tax returns have been examined through 1993 in the Philippines and through 1994 in the U.S. The recorded provision for open years is subject to changes upon final examination of these tax returns. Changes in the mix of income from the Company's foreign subsidiaries, expiration of tax holidays and changes in tax laws or regulations could result in increased effective tax rates for the Company. At December 31, 1997, the financial reporting basis of AEI's net assets were greater than the tax basis of the net assets by approximately $5,200. In connection with the Initial Public Offering, the Company and the stockholders of AEI will enter into a Tax Indemnification Agreement providing that the Company and AEI will be indemnified by such stockholders, with respect to their proportionate share of any federal or state corporate income taxes attributable to the failure of AEI to qualify as an S Corporation for any period or in any jurisdiction for which S Corporation status was claimed through the date AEI terminates its S Corporation status. The Tax Indemnification Agreement will also provide that the Company and AEI will indemnify the stockholders if such stockholders are required to include in income additional amounts attributable to taxable years on or before the date AEI terminates its S Corporation status as to which AEI filed or files tax returns claiming status as an S Corporation. 11. RELATED-PARTY TRANSACTIONS At December 31, 1997, the Company owned 8.1% of the outstanding stock of AICL (see Note 6), and AICL owned 40% of AAP. After the Initial Public Offering (see Note 16) the Company intends to purchase AICL's interest in AAP for approximately $34,000. In 1996 and 1997, approximately 72% and 68%, respectively, of the Company's net revenues (see Note 1) were derived from services performed for the Company by AICL, a Korean public company in which the Company and certain of the Company's principal stockholders hold a minority interest. By the terms of a long-standing agreement, the Company has been responsible for marketing and selling AICL's semiconductor packaging and test services, except to customers in Korea and certain customers in Japan to whom AICL has historically sold such services directly. The Company has worked closely with AICL in developing new technologies and products. The Company has recently entered into five-year supply agreements with AICL giving the Company the first right to market and sell substantially all of AICL's packaging and test services and the exclusive right to market and sell all of the wafer output of AICL's new wafer foundry. The Company's business, financial condition and operating results have been and will continue to be significantly dependent on the ability of AICL to effectively provide the contracted services on a cost-efficient and timely basis. The termination of the Company's relationship with AICL for any reason, or any material adverse change in AICL's business resulting from underutilization of its capacity, the level of its debt and its guarantees of affiliate debt, labor disruptions, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates, changes in governmental policies, economic or political conditions in Korea or any other change could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company has obtained a significant portion of its financing from financing arrangements provided by Anam USA, Inc. ("AUSA"), AICL's wholly-owned financing subsidiary. A majority of the amount due to AUSA represents outstanding amounts under financing obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company with the balance representing payables to AUSA for packaging and service charges paid to AICL. Based on guarantees provided by AICL, AUSA obtains for the benefit of the Company a continuous series of short-term financing arrangements which generally are less than six months in duration, and typically are less than two months in duration. Because of the short-term nature of these loans, the flows of cash to and from AUSA F-20 101 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) under this arrangement are significant. Purchases from AICL through AUSA were $354,062, $460,282 and $527,858 for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. Charges from AUSA for interest and bank charges were $4,484, $7,074 and $6,002 for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. Amounts payable to AICL and AUSA were $252,221, and $156,350 at December 31, 1996 and 1997, respectively. AICL's ability to continue to provide services to the Company will depend on AICL's financial condition and performance. AICL currently has a significant amount of debt relative to its equity, which debt the Company expects will continue to increase in the foreseeable future. The Company is advised that AICL, as a public company in Korea, has published its most recent annual consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 1997. These consolidated financial statements are prepared on the basis of Korean GAAP, which differs from U.S. GAAP. U.S. GAAP financial statements are not available (See Note 6). As of December 31, 1997, AICL, on a consolidated basis, had current liabilities of approximately W2,124 billion, including approximately W1,721 billion of short-term borrowings and approximately W121 billion of current maturities of long-term debt, and had long-term liabilities of approximately W1,710 billion, including approximately W737 billion of long-term debt and approximately W862 billion of long-term capital lease obligations. As of such date, the total shareholders' equity of AICL amounted to approximately W77 billion. The deterioration of the Korean economy in recent months and the resulting liquidity crisis in Korea have led to sharply higher domestic interest rates and reduced opportunities for refinancing or refunding maturing debts as financial institutions in Korea, which are experiencing financial difficulties, are increasingly looking to limit their lending, particularly to highly leveraged companies, and to increase their reserves and provisions for non-performing assets. Therefore, there can be no assurance that AICL will be able to refinance its existing loans or obtain new loans, or continue to make required interest and principal payments on such loans or otherwise comply with the terms of its loan agreements. Any inability of AICL to obtain financing or generate cash flow from operations sufficient to fund its capital expenditure, debt service and repayment and other working capital and liquidity requirements could have a material adverse effect on AICL's ability to continue to provide services and otherwise fulfill its obligations to the Company. As of December 31, 1997, AICL and its consolidated subsidiaries were contingently liable under guarantees in respect of debt of its non-consolidated subsidiaries and affiliates in the aggregate amount of approximately W857 billion. As of December 31, 1997, such guarantees included those in respect of all of AUSA's debt totaling $319,200, $176,250 of the Company's debt to banks and the Company's obligations under a receivables sales arrangement (see Note 2). The Company has met a significant portion of its financing needs through financing arrangements obtained by AUSA for the benefit of the Company based on guarantees provided by AICL. There can be no assurance that AUSA will be able to obtain additional guarantees, if necessary, from AICL. Further, a deterioration in AICL's financial condition could trigger defaults under AICL's guarantees, causing acceleration of such loans. In addition, as an overseas subsidiary of AICL, AUSA was formed with the approval of the Bank of Korea. If the Bank of Korea were to withdraw such approval, or if AUSA otherwise ceased operations for any reason, the Company and AICL would be required to meet their financing needs through alternative arrangements. There can be no assurance that the Company or AICL will be able to obtain alternative financing on acceptable terms or at all. In addition, if any relevant subsidiaries or affiliates of AICL were to fail to make interest or principal payments or otherwise default under their debt obligations guaranteed by AICL, AICL could be required under its guarantees to repay such debt, which event could have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations. Anam Engineering and Construction, an affiliate of AICL, built the packaging facility for AAAP in the Philippines. Payments to Anam Engineering and Construction were $22,167 and $3,844 in 1996 and 1997, respectively. Anam Precision Equipment and Anam Instruments manufacture certain equipment used by the Philippine operations. Payments to Anam Precision Equipment and Anam Instruments were $6,652 and F-21 102 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) $4,211 in 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company purchases direct materials from Anam S&T. Payments to Anam S&T were approximately $16,400, $27,300 and $26,000 during 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. During 1996, the Company extended guarantees on behalf of an affiliate to vendors used by this affiliate. Outstanding guarantees as of December 31, 1996 and 1997 were $25,100 and $24,655 respectively. Amounts guaranteed under this agreement fluctuate due to the cyclical nature of the affiliate's retail business. Balances guaranteed at December 31 are generally the largest. The Company has executed a surety and guarantee agreement on behalf of an affiliate. The Company has unconditionally guaranteed the affiliate's obligation under a $17,000 line of credit and a $9,000 term loan note. As of December 31, 1997, there was $750 outstanding under the line of credit and $9,000 outstanding under the term loan note. The Company has also unconditionally guaranteed another affiliate's obligation under a $4,000 term loan agreement and a $1,000 line of credit. As of December 31, 1997, there was $3,800 outstanding under the term loan and no amounts outstanding under the line of credit. A principal stockholder of the Company has extended guarantees on behalf of the Company in the amount of $87,000 at December 31, 1997. Also in 1997, a company controlled by this stockholder purchased investments in the amount of $49,740 (see Note 6). The Company leases office space in West Chester, PA from certain stockholders of the Company. The lease expires in 2006. The Company has the option to extend the lease for an additional 10 years through 2016. On September 11, 1997, the office previously being leased in Chandler, Arizona was purchased from certain stockholders of the Company. The total purchase price of the building ($5,710) represents the carrying value to the stockholders. Amounts paid for these leases in 1996 and 1997 were $1,343 and $1,458, respectively. At December 31, 1996 and 1997, the Company had advances and notes receivable from affiliates other than AICL and AUSA of $22,988 and $36,501, respectively. Realization of these notes is dependent upon the ability of the affiliates to repay the notes. In management's opinion, these receivables are recorded at the net realizable value. 12. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS The estimated fair value of financial instruments has been determined by the Company using available market information and appropriate methodologies; however, considerable judgment is required in interpreting market data to develop the estimates for fair value. Accordingly, these estimates are not necessarily indicative of the amounts that the Company could realize in a current market exchange. Certain of these financial instruments are with major financial institutions and expose the Company to market and credit risks and may at times be concentrated with certain counterparties or groups of counterparties. The creditworthiness of counterparties is continually reviewed, and full performance is anticipated. The methods and assumptions used to estimate the fair value of significant classes of financial instruments is set forth below: Available for sale investments. The fair value of these financial instruments was estimated based on market quotes, recent offerings of similar securities, current and projected financial performance of the company and net asset positions. Short-term borrowings. Short-term borrowings have variable rates that reflect currently available terms and conditions for similar borrowings. The carrying amount of this debt is a reasonable estimate of fair value. Long-term debt and due to affiliates. Long-term debt and due to affiliates have variable rates that reflect currently available terms and conditions for similar debt. The carrying amount of this debt is a reasonable estimate of fair value. F-22 103 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) 13. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES The Company is involved in various claims incidental to the conduct of its business. Based on consultation with legal counsel, management does not believe that any claims to which the Company is a party will have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial condition or results of operations. Future minimum lease payments under operating leases that have initial or remaining noncancelable lease terms in excess of one year at December 31, 1997, are: 1998............................................... $ 7,805 1999............................................... 7,230 2000............................................... 6,463 2001............................................... 5,689 2002............................................... 2,338 Thereafter......................................... 36,404 ------- Total.................................... $65,929 =======
Rent expense amounted to $3,692, $5,520 and $6,709 for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. The Company has various purchase commitments for materials, supplies and capital equipment incidental to the ordinary conduct of business. As of December 31, 1997 the Company had commitments for capital equipment of approximately $27,000. In the aggregate, such commitments are not at prices in excess of current market. 14. ACQUISITION OF AMKOR ANAM TEST SERVICES, INC. On September 30, 1996, AEI and a principal stockholder each acquired 50% of the outstanding common stock of Amkor Anam Test Services, Inc. (AATS), formerly Navell Test Consultants, Inc., a provider of test engineering services for the semiconductor industry located in San Jose, California, for approximately $2,860. Subsequent to September 30, 1996, AEI purchased the 50% interest owned by a principal stockholder at the stockholder's original cost. The acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting and the results of AATS' operations are included in the Company's combined statements of income effective October 1, 1996. Accordingly, the total purchase price has been allocated to the combined assets and liabilities based upon their estimated respective fair values. This acquisition resulted in goodwill of approximately $2,356, which is being amortized over 20 years. F-23 104 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) 15. BUSINESS SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION The Company is primarily engaged in one industry segment, namely, the packaging and testing of integrated circuits. Financial information, summarized by geographic area, is as follows:
UNITED STATES EUROPE PHILIPPINES ELIMINATIONS COMBINED ---------- -------- ----------- ------------ ---------- Year ended December 31, 1997: Net revenues from unaffiliated customers.................. $1,258,110 $197,651 $ -- $ -- $1,455,761 Net revenues from affiliates................. -- -- 256,895 (256,895) -- ---------- -------- -------- --------- ---------- Total net revenues............ 1,258,110 197,651 256,895 (256,895) 1,455,761 Income before income taxes and minority interest.......... 28,086 23,522 9,398 -- 61,006 Identifiable assets........... 352,503 21,873 506,397 (176,134) 704,639 Corporate assets.............. 146,299 ---------- Total assets.......... $ 850,938 ========== Year ended December 31, 1996: Net revenues from unaffiliated customers.................. $1,013,182 $157,819 $ -- $ -- $1,171,001 Net revenues from affiliates................. -- -- 198,637 (198,637) -- ---------- -------- -------- --------- ---------- Total net revenues............ 1,013,182 157,819 198,637 (198,637) 1,171,001 Income before income taxes and minority interest.......... 22,592 12,473 7,947 -- 43,012 Identifiable assets........... 245,781 19,422 424,653 (91,552) 598,304 Corporate assets.............. 199,309 ---------- Total assets.......... $ 797,613 ========== Year ended December 31, 1995: Net revenues from unaffiliated customers.................. $ 792,285 $140,097 $ -- $ -- $ 932,382 Net revenues from affiliates................. -- -- 128,164 (128,164) -- ---------- -------- -------- --------- ---------- Total net revenues............ 792,285 140,097 128,164 (128,164) 932,382 Income before income taxes and minority interest.......... 43,223 13,019 10,781 -- 67,023 Identifiable assets........... 235,707 18,699 270,185 (100,385) 424,206 Corporate assets.............. 211,662 ---------- Total assets.......... $ 635,868 ==========
Sales between affiliates are priced at customer selling price less material costs provided by the segment, less a sales commission. Net revenues from unaffiliated customers for the United States include $109,532, $160,507 and $208,062 of revenues from unaffiliated foreign customers for 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively. Identifiable assets are those assets that can be directly associated with a particular geographic area. Corporate assets are those assets which are not directly associated with a particular geographic area and consist primarily of cash and cash equivalents, investments and advances or loans to another geographic segment. F-24 105 AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. AND AK INDUSTRIES, INC. NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (U.S. DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA) 16. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS Reorganization -- On April 14, 1998, Mr. and Mrs. James Kim and the Kim Family Trusts exchanged their interests in AEI for 9,746,766 shares and 4,873,383 shares of ATI common stock, respectively. On April 29, 1998, ATI issued 67,989,851 shares of common stock in exchange for all of the outstanding shares of AIH and its subsidiaries. Of such shares, 19,328,234 shares, 36,376,617 shares and 8,200,000 shares were gifted to Mr. and Mrs. James Kim, the Kim Family Trusts and other members of Mr. Kim's immediate family, respectively. In addition, ATI acquired all of the stock of AKI from the Kim Family Trusts for $3,000. Except for the acquisition of the shares of AKI which has been accounted for as a purchase transaction, the Reorganization described above is treated similar to a pooling of interests as it represents an exchange of equity interests among companies under common control. The purchase price for the AKI stock, which represents the fair value of these shares, approximates the book value of AKI (See Note 1 regarding the basis of presentation and income taxes). Initial Public Offering -- ATI filed an amended registration statement on April 29, 1998 with the Securities and Exchange Commission. On May 6, 1998, ATI completed its Initial Public Offering of 30,000,000 shares of its common stock at a price to the public of $11.00 per share and $180,000 aggregate principal amount of Convertible Notes ("Initial Public Offering"). Also on May 8, 1998, ATI sold 5,250,000 additional shares of its common stock and $27,000 additional principal amounts of Convertible Notes in conjunction with the underwriters' over-allotment options. The net proceeds were approximately $559,757, after deducting the underwriter discounts and estimated offering expenses. (See Note 1) The convertible notes 1) are convertible into ATI common stock at $13.50 per share; 2) are callable in certain circumstances after three years; 3) are unsecured and subordinate to senior debt; 4) carry a coupon rate of 5 3/4%; and 5) have a maturity of five years. Approximately $227,000 of the proceeds will be used to reduce short-term and long-term borrowings. Approximately $86,000 of the proceeds will be used to reduce amounts due to AUSA. In connection with the Offerings, one existing stockholder sold approximately 5,000,000 of his shares. The Company established stock option plans in 1998 pursuant to which 6,550,000 shares of common stock were reserved for future issuance upon the exercise of stock options granted to employees, consultants and directors. The options will be issued at fair value and generally will vest over four years. After the Initial Public Offering, the Company intends to purchase AICL's 40% interest in AAP for approximately $34,000. The Company will account for this transaction as a purchase which will result in the elimination of the minority interest liability reflected on the combined balance sheet and result in additional amortization of approximately $2,500 per year. 17. PRO FORMA ADJUSTMENTS Statement of Income Pro forma adjustments are presented to reflect a provision for income taxes as if AEI had not been an S Corporation for all of the periods presented. Pro forma net income per common share is based on the weighted average number of shares outstanding as if the Exchange had occurred at the beginning of the period presented. Balance Sheet As discussed in Note 1, the Company reorganized prior to the effective date of the offering. AEI terminated its S Corporation status at which time additional deferred tax assets of $1,500 were recorded for existing temporary differences between the book and tax bases of assets and liabilities. If the termination of AEI's S Corporation status would have occurred on March 31, 1998, AEI would have declared a distribution of $35,700 of previously taxed income. The pro forma balance sheet is presented to reflect these changes as if they occurred on March 31, 1998. F-25 106 INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT To the Shareholders and Board of Directors Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. We have audited the consolidated balance sheets of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and its subsidiaries (the "Company") as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the related consolidated statements of operations, capital surplus and retained earnings (accumulated deficit), and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997 (which financial statements are prepared under generally accepted accounting principles in the Republic of Korea and are not included in this Registration Statement). These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We did not audit the financial statements of Anam USA, Inc. ("Anam USA"), a wholly owned subsidiary, and Anam Engineering and Construction Co., Ltd. ("Anam Construction"), a 59.6% owned subsidiary, which statements reflect total assets of W913,721 million and W660,729 million as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and total net income (loss) of W(10,011) million in 1997, W5,738 million in 1996 and W(2,925) million in 1995. Additionally, we did not audit the financial statements of Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. ("AAPI"), a 40% owned affiliate, the investment in which is reflected in the accompanying financial statements using the equity method of accounting. The Company's investment in AAPI was W38,612 million and W19,077 million as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively, and the equity in its net income (loss) was W(44,491) million in 1997, W2,050 million in 1996 and W(1,570) million in 1995. The aforementioned financial statements were audited by other auditors whose reports have been furnished to us, and our opinion, insofar as it relates to the amounts included for Anam USA, Anam Construction and AAPI, is based solely on the reports of the other auditors. The auditors of Anam Construction and AAPI expressed uncertainties in their audit reports about the respective companies' ability to continue as a going concern. We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards in the Republic of Korea, which are substantially the same as those followed in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits and the reports of other auditors provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, based on our audits and the reports of other auditors, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the Republic of Korea. As discussed in Note 2 to the financial statements, in accordance with revised Financial Accounting Standards in the Republic of Korea effective in 1997 and 1996, respectively, the Company changed its method of accounting for unrealized foreign currency translation gains or losses on long-term assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies. In 1997, such gains or losses are deferred and amortized over the lives or maturities of corresponding assets and liabilities using the straight-line method. In 1996, such gains or losses had been recorded as a capital adjustment to shareholders' equity. Prior to 1996, such gains or losses had been recognized currently. The financial statements referred to above have been prepared assuming that the Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 3 to the financial statements, the operations of the Company have been significantly affected, and will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by Korea's unstable economy caused by currency volatility and unstable finance markets in Korea. The Company has traditionally operated with a significant amount of debt relative to its equity and has a significant working capital deficit at F-26 107 December 31, 1997. Because of Korea's unstable economy and the Company's dependence on debt financing, there are significant uncertainties that may affect the Company's future operations and its ability to maintain or refinance certain debt obligations as they mature, which raise substantial doubt regarding the Company's ability to continue as a going concern. The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot be determined presently and the financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from these uncertainties. Management's plans to address these matters are also included in Note 3. SAMIL ACCOUNTING CORPORATION Seoul, Korea March 20, 1998 F-27 108 INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT To the Board of Directors and Stockholders Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd. We have audited the balance sheets of Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd. (the Company) as of December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, and the related statements of operations and accumulated deficit and cash flows for the years then ended (not included in this Prospectus or elsewhere in this Registration Statement). These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards in the Republic of Korea which are substantially the same as those followed in the United States. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Anam Engineering & Construction Co., Ltd. as of December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, and the results of its operations and the changes in its accumulated deficit and its cash flows for the years then ended, in conformity with generally accepted financial accounting standards in the Republic of Korea. The financial statements referred to above have been prepared assuming that the Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in Note 20 to the financial statements, the operations of the Company have been significantly affected, and will continue to be affected for the foreseeable future, by Korea's unstable economy caused by the currency volatility and unstable financial markets in Korea. The Company has traditionally operated with a significant amount of debt relative to its equity. Because of Korea's unstable economy and the Company's dependence on debt financing, there are significant uncertainties that may affect the Company's future operations and its abilities to maintain or regarding the Company's ability to continue as a going concern. The ultimate outcome of these uncertainties cannot be determined presently and financial statements do not include adjustments that might result from these uncertainties. As discussed in Note 17 to the financial statements, the Company executed a merger in which the operations of Hanyong Corporation were combined with the Company as of July 31, 1997. This merger was accounted for as a transfer of assets and liabilities under common control at historical costs in a manner similar to a pooling of interest of U.S. GAAP reporting purposes. As discussed in Note 14 to financial statements, the Company sells its product to Anam Semiconductor Inc. (Anam Industrial Co., Ltd.) and other affiliated companies. The amounts of sales are W244,013 million, W313,894 million and W47,109 million during the year ended December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995, and balances of account receivable are W31,844 million, W53,816 million and W79,316 million at December 31, 1997, 1996 and 1995 respectively and balances of account payable are W4,834 million, W122 million and W403 million at December 31 of 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively. The amounts expressed in U.S. Dollars, presented solely for the convenience of the reader, have been translated on the basis set forth in Note 3 to financial statements. Chong Un & Company Seoul, Korea March 4, 1998 F-28 109 REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS The Stockholders and the Board of Directors Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. NSC Compound, Km. 22 East Service Road South Superhighway, Muntinlupa City We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 1997 and December 29, 1996, and the related consolidated statements of income and retained earnings (deficit) and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 1997 and December 29, 1996, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the Philippines. SyCip Gorres Velayo & Co January 30, 1998 (except with respect to the Initial Public Offering discussed in Note 1 which is dated May 8, 1998). Makati City, Philippines F-29 110 INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT To the Board of Directors Anam USA, Inc. West Chester, Pennsylvania We have audited the balance sheets of Anam USA, Inc. (a Pennsylvania Corporation and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Anam Industrial Co., Ltd., Seoul, ROK) as of December 31, 1997 and 1996 and the related statements of income, stockholder's equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Anam USA, Inc. as of December 31, 1997 and 1996 and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the years then ended in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. SIANA CARR & O'CONNOR, LLP Paoli, Pennsylvania February 13, 1998 F-30 111 ====================================================== NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR ANY OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFER MADE BY THIS PROSPECTUS AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY OR SALOMON SMITH BARNEY. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES, CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY SINCE THE DATES AS OF WHICH THE INFORMATION IS GIVEN IN THIS PROSPECTUS. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER OR SOLICITATION BY ANYONE IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED OR IN WHICH THE PERSON MAKING SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO OR TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH SOLICITATION. ------------------ TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE ---- Additional Information................. 2 Prospectus Summary..................... 3 Risk Factors........................... 8 Reorganization......................... 24 Relationship with AICL................. 26 Use of Proceeds........................ 31 Dividend Policy........................ 31 Capitalization......................... 32 Selected Combined Financial Data....... 34 Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations........................... 36 Business............................... 47 Management............................. 62 Certain Transactions................... 68 Principal Stockholders................. 71 Description of Capital Stock........... 73 Shares Eligible for Future Sale........ 75 Plan of Distribution................... 76 Legal Matters.......................... 76 Experts................................ 77 Glossary............................... 78 Index to Combined Financial Statements........................... F-1
------------------ UNTIL JUNE 16, 1998 (25 DAYS AFTER THE COMMENCEMENT OF THIS OFFERING), ALL DEALERS EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN THE COMMON STOCK, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS. THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS. ====================================================== ====================================================== COMMON STOCK AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. LOGO ------------ PROSPECTUS MAY 22, 1998 ------------ ====================================================== 112 PART II INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS ITEM 13. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION The following table sets forth the costs and expenses, other than underwriting discounts, commissions and certain accountable expenses, payable by the Company in connection with the sale of Common Stock being registered. All amounts are estimates except the SEC registration fee and the Nasdaq listing fee. SEC Registration Fee........................................ $ 24,780 Printing Fees and Expenses.................................. 20,000 Legal Fees and Expenses..................................... 100,000 Accounting Fees and Expenses................................ 100,000 Miscellaneous............................................... 55,220 -------- Total............................................. $300,000 ========
ITEM 14. INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law permits a corporation to include in its charter documents, and in agreements between the corporation and its directors and officers, provisions expanding the scope of indemnification beyond that specifically provided by the current law. The Company's Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation provides for the indemnification of directors to the fullest extent permissible under Delaware law. The Company's Bylaws provide for the indemnification of officers, directors and third parties acting on behalf of the Company if such person acted in good faith and in a manner reasonably believed to be in and not opposed to the best interest of the Company, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, the indemnified party had no reason to believe his conduct was unlawful. The Company has entered into indemnification agreements with its directors and executive officers, in addition to indemnification provided for in the Company's Bylaws, and intends to enter into indemnification agreements with any new directors and executive officers in the future. The form of Underwriting Agreement entered into in connection with the Company's Initial Public Offering provides for the indemnification of the Company's directors and officers in certain circumstances as provided therein. ITEM 15. RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES Prior to the Initial Public Offering, 82,610,000 shares of Common Stock were issued to Mr. James Kim and members of his family in exchange for their outstanding interests in the Amkor Companies. Such issuances were made pursuant to an exemption from registration under Section 4(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. See "Reorganization" in Part I hereof. The recipients of securities in each such transaction represented their intention to acquire the securities for investment only and not with a view to or for sale in connection with any distribution thereof and appropriate legends were affixed to the share certificates issued in such transactions. All recipients had adequate access, through their relationships with the Company, to information about the Company. II-1 113 ITEM 16. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULE (a) Exhibits 2.1 Amendment and Plan of Reorganization dated April 14, 1998 between Amkor Technology, Inc., Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI") and the stockholders of AEI.** 2.2 Stock Purchase Agreement dated April 21, 1998 between Guardian Assets, Inc. and the stockholders of AK Industries, Inc.** 2.3 Agreement dated April 29, 1998 between Cotswold Investments, Ltd., and Amkor Technology, Inc.** 2.4 Agreement dated April 29, 1998 between Turquoise Investments, Ltd. and Amkor Technology, Inc.** 3.1 Certificate of Incorporation.** 3.2 Bylaws.** 4.1 Specimen Common Stock Certificate.** 4.2 Form of Indenture.** 5.1 Opinion of Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation, as to the legality of the securities being registered.* 10.1 Form of Indemnification Agreement for directors and officers.** 10.2 1998 Stock Plan and form of agreement thereunder.** 10.3 Receivables Purchase Agreement between Amkor Electronics, Inc. and Amkor Receivables Corp., dated June 20, 1997.** 10.4 Form of Tax Indemnification Agreement between Amkor Technology, Inc., Amkor Electronics, Inc. and certain stockholders of Amkor Technology, Inc.** 10.5 Bridge Loan Agreement between Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc., Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and the Korea Development Bank for $55,000,000, dated July 1997.** 10.6 Loan Agreement between Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. and the Korea Development Bank for $71,000,000, dated March 28, 1996.** 10.7 Loan Agreement between Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. and the Korea Development Bank for $50,000,000, dated September 7, 1995.** 10.8 Commercial Office Lease between Chandler Corporate Center Phase II, G.P. and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated September 6, 1993.** 10.9 Commercial Office Lease between the 12/31/87 Trusts of Susan Y., David D. and John T. Kim and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated October 1, 1996.** 10.10 Commercial Office Lease between the 12/31/87 Trusts of Susan Y., David D., and John T. Kim and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated June 14, 1996.** 10.11 Contract of Lease between Corinthian Commercial Corporation and Amkor/Anam Pilipinas Inc., dated October 1, 1990.** 10.12 Contract of Lease between Salcedo Sunvar Realty Corporation and Automated Microelectronics, Inc., dated May 6, 1994.** 10.13 Lease Contract between AAP Realty Corporation and Amkor/Anam Advanced Packaging, Inc., dated November 6, 1996.** 10.14 Immunity Agreement between Amkor Electronics, Inc. and Motorola, Inc., dated June 30, 1993.+** 10.15 Assembly Agreement between Amkor Electronics, Inc. and Intel Corporation, dated July 17, 1991.+** 10.16 1998 Director Option Plan and form of agreement thereunder.**
II-2 114 10.17 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.** 10.18 Performance Undertaking between Amkor Receivables Corp. and Anam Industrial Co., Ltd., dated June 20, 1997.** 10.19 Packaging and Test Services Agreement by and among Amkor Technology, Inc., Amkor Electronics, Inc., C.I.L. Limited, Anam USA, Inc. and Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. dated January 1, 1998.** 10.20 Foundry Services Agreement by and among Amkor Electronics, Inc., C.I.L. Limited, Anam Industries Co., Ltd. and Anam USA dated as of January 1, 1998.** 10.21 Amendment to Technical Assistance Agreement dated as of September 29, 1997 between Texas Instruments Incorporated and Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and related portions of Technical Assistance Agreement dated as of January 28, 1997.+** 10.22 Form of Registration Rights Agreement between Amkor Technology, Inc. and Smith Barney Inc. in consideration of the Master Securities Loan Agreement.** 10.23 Manufacturing and Purchase Agreement between Texas Instruments Incorporated, Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated as of January 1, 1998.+** 10.24 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees.** 12.1 Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.** 21.1 List of Subsidiaries of the Registrant.** 23.1 Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP. 23.2 Consent of Counsel (included in Exhibit 5.1).* 23.3 Consent of Samil Accounting Corporation 23.4 Consent of Chong Un & Company* 23.5 Consent of SyCip Gorres Velayo & Co 23.6 Consent of Siana Carr & O'Connor, LLP* 24.1 Power of Attorney.* 27.1 Financial Data Schedule. 99.1 Form of Securities Loan Agreement between Smith Barney Inc. and James J. Kim and Agnes C. Kim.** 99.2 Form of Custodial Undertaking in connection with Securities Loan Agreement by and among James J. Kim and Agnes C. Kim, Smith Barney Inc. and the Chase Manhattan Bank.**
- --------------- * Filed previously. ** Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed October 6, 1997, as amended (File No. 333-37235). + Confidential Treatment requested as to certain portions of this exhibit. SCHEDULE II -- VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS Schedules not listed above have been omitted because the information required to be set forth therein is not applicable or is shown in the financial statements or notes thereto. ITEM 17. UNDERTAKINGS Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers, and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the provisions described in Item 14 above, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by II-3 115 the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer, or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit, or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer, or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933, and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue. The undersigned Registrant undertakes that: (1) for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus as filed as part of the registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in the form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective, and (2) for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof. The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes: (1) To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement: (i) To include any prospectus required by section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act. (ii) To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising after the effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth in the registration statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of prospectus filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) if, in the aggregate, the changes in volume and price represent no more than a 20% change in the maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the "Calculation of Registration Fee" table in the effective registration statement. (iii) To include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or any material change to such information in the registration statement. (2) That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof; (3) To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the offering; and (4) That, for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each filing of the registrant's annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act (and, where applicable, each filing of an employee benefit plan's annual report pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act) that is incorporated by reference in the registration statement shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof. II-4 116 SIGNATURES Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement on Form S-1 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of West Chester, State of Pennsylvania, on the 22nd day of May 1998. AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. By: /s/ JAMES J. KIM ------------------------------------ James J. Kim Chief Executive Officer and Secretary PURSUANT TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON FORM S-1 HAS BEEN SIGNED BY THE FOLLOWING PERSONS IN THE CAPACITIES AND ON THE DATES INDICATED.
SIGNATURE TITLE DATE --------- ----- ---- /s/ JAMES J. KIM Chief Executive Officer and May 22, 1998 - --------------------------------------------------- Chairman James J. Kim * Chief Financial Officer and May 22, 1998 - --------------------------------------------------- Secretary (Principal Financial Frank J. Marcucci and Accounting Officer) * President and Director May 22, 1998 - --------------------------------------------------- John N. Boruch * Director May 22, 1998 - --------------------------------------------------- Thomas D. George * Director May 22, 1998 - --------------------------------------------------- Gregory K. Hinckley * /s/ JAMES J. KIM - --------------------------------------------------- James J. Kim Attorney-in-fact
II-5 117 INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES*
SEQUENTIALLY SCHEDULE NUMBERED NUMBER DESCRIPTION OF SCHEDULES PAGE - -------- ------------------------ ------------ Report of Independent Public Accountants.................... S-2 II Valuation and Qualifying Accounts........................... S-3
- --------------- * All other schedules are omitted as the required information is inapplicable or the information is presented in the financial statements or related notes. S-1 118 REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS To Amkor Technology, Inc.: We have audited in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards, the Combined Financial Statements of Amkor Technology, Inc. and AK Industries, Inc. and subsidiaries (See Note 1 to the Combined Financial Statements) included in this registration statement and have issued our report thereon dated February 3, 1998 (except with respect to the sale of the investment in Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. common stock discussed in Note 6 to the Combined Financial Statements as to which the date is February 16, 1998, the Reorganization as to which the date is April 29, 1998 and the Initial Public Offering as to which the date is May 8, 1998). Our audit was made for the purpose of forming an opinion on the basic financial statements taken as a whole. The schedule listed in the index above is presented for the purpose of complying with the Securities and Exchange Commissions rules and is not part of the basic financial statements. This schedule has been subjected to the auditing procedures applied in the audit of the basic financial statements and, in our opinion, fairly states in all material respects the financial data required to be set forth therein in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole. ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP Philadelphia, Pa. February 3, 1998 (except with respect to the sale of the investment in Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. common stock discussed in Note 6 to the Combined Financial Statements as to which the date is February 16, 1998, the Reorganization as to which the date is April 29, 1998 and the Initial Public Offering as to which the date is May 8, 1998). S-2 119 SCHEDULE II AMKOR TECHNOLOGY, INC. VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS (AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)
BALANCE AT ADDITIONS BALANCE AT BEGINNING CHARGED TO END OF PERIOD EXPENSE WRITE-OFFS OTHER OF PERIOD ---------- ---------- ---------- -------- ---------- Year ended December 31, 1995: Allowance for doubtful accounts................ $ 487 $ 500 $ -- $ 56 $ 1,043 Year ended December 31, 1996: Allowance for doubtful accounts................ $ 1,043 $ 660 $ (564) $ 40 $ 1,179 Year ended December 31, 1997: Allowance for doubtful accounts................ $ 1,179 $ 3,490 $ (435) -- $ 4,234
S-3 120 EXHIBIT INDEX
SEQUENTIALLY EXHIBIT NUMBERED NUMBER DESCRIPTION OF DOCUMENT PAGE ------- ------------------------------------------------------------ ------------ 2.1 Amendment and Plan of Reorganization dated April 14, 1998 between Amkor Technology, Inc., Amkor Electronics, Inc. ("AEI") and the stockholders of AEI.** 2.2 Stock Purchase Agreement dated April 21, 1998 between Guardian Assets, Inc. and the stockholders of AK Industries, Inc.** 2.3 Agreement dated April 29, 1998 between Cotswold Investments, Ltd., and Amkor Technology, Inc.** 2.4 Agreement dated April 29, 1998 between Turquoise Investments, Ltd. and Amkor Technology, Inc.** 3.1 Certificate of Incorporation.** 3.2 Bylaws.** 4.1 Specimen Common Stock Certificate.** 4.2 Form of Indenture.** 5.1 Opinion of Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation, as to the legality of the securities being registered.* 10.1 Form of Indemnification Agreement for directors and officers.** 10.2 1998 Stock Plan and form of agreement thereunder.** 10.3 Receivables Purchase Agreement between Amkor Electronics, Inc. and Amkor Receivables Corp., dated June 20, 1997.** 10.4 Form of Tax Indemnification Agreement between Amkor Technology, Inc., Amkor Electronics, Inc. and certain stockholders of Amkor Technology, Inc.** 10.5 Bridge Loan Agreement between Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc., Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and the Korea Development Bank for $55,000,000, dated July 1997.** 10.6 Loan Agreement between Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. and the Korea Development Bank for $71,000,000, dated March 28, 1996.** 10.7 Loan Agreement between Amkor/Anam Pilipinas, Inc. and the Korea Development Bank for $50,000,000, dated September 7, 1995.** 10.8 Commercial Office Lease between Chandler Corporate Center Phase II, G.P. and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated September 6, 1993.** 10.9 Commercial Office Lease between the 12/31/87 Trusts of Susan Y., David D. and John T. Kim and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated October 1, 1996.** 10.10 Commercial Office Lease between the 12/31/87 Trusts of Susan Y., David D., and John T. Kim and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated June 14, 1996.** 10.11 Contract of Lease between Corinthian Commercial Corporation and Amkor/Anam Pilipinas Inc., dated October 1, 1990.** 10.12 Contract of Lease between Salcedo Sunvar Realty Corporation and Automated Microelectronics, Inc., dated May 6, 1994.** 10.13 Lease Contract between AAP Realty Corporation and Amkor/Anam Advanced Packaging, Inc., dated November 6, 1996.** 10.14 Immunity Agreement between Amkor Electronics, Inc. and Motorola, Inc., dated June 30, 1993.+**
121
SEQUENTIALLY EXHIBIT NUMBERED NUMBER DESCRIPTION OF DOCUMENT PAGE ------- ------------------------------------------------------------ ------------ 10.15 Assembly Agreement between Amkor Electronics, Inc. and Intel Corporation, dated July 17, 1991.+** 10.16 1998 Director Option Plan and form of agreement thereunder.** 10.17 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.** 10.18 Performance Undertaking between Amkor Receivables Corp. and Anam Industrial Co., Ltd., dated June 20, 1997.** 10.19 Packaging and Test Services Agreement by and among Amkor Technology, Inc., Amkor Electronics, Inc., C.I.L. Limited, Anam USA, Inc. and Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. dated January 1, 1998.** 10.20 Foundry Services Agreement by and among Amkor Electronics, Inc., C.I.L. Limited, Anam Industries Co., Ltd. and Anam USA dated as of January 1, 1998.** 10.21 Amendment to Technical Assistance Agreement dated as of September 29, 1997 between Texas Instruments Incorporated and Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and related portions of Technical Assistance Agreement dated as of January 28, 1997.+** 10.22 Form of Registration Rights Agreement between Amkor Technology, Inc. and Smith Barney Inc. in consideration of the Master Securities Loan Agreement.** 10.23 Manufacturing and Purchase Agreement between Texas Instruments Incorporated, Anam Industrial Co., Ltd. and Amkor Electronics, Inc., dated as of January 1, 1998.+** 10.24 1998 Stock Option Plan for French Employees.** 12.1 Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.** 21.1 List of Subsidiaries of the Registrant.** 23.1 Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP. 23.2 Consent of Counsel (included in Exhibit 5.1).* 23.3 Consent of Samil Accounting Corporation 23.4 Consent of Chong Un & Company* 23.5 Consent of SyCip Gorres Velayo & Co 23.6 Consent of Siana Carr & O'Connor, LLP* 24.1 Power of Attorney.* 27.1 Financial Data Schedule. 99.1 Form of Securities Loan Agreement between Smith Barney Inc. and James J. Kim and Agnes C. Kim.* 99.2 Form of Custodial Undertaking in connection with Securities Loan Agreement by and among James J. Kim and Agnes C. Kim, Smith Barney Inc. and the Chase Manhattan Bank.*
- --------------- * Previously filed. ** Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed October 6, 1997, as amended (File No. 333-37235). + Confidential Treatment requested as to certain portions of this exhibit.
   1

                                                                   EXHIBIT 23.1


                   CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS

   

As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of our reports
and to all references to our Firm included in or made a part of this 
Post-Effective Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement (File No. 
333-49645) on Form S-1.
    

                                      ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP

                                      /s/ Arthur Andersen LLP

   
Philadelphia, Pa.
May 19, 1998
    

   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.3

 
                   CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS


     We hereby consent to the inclusion in this Post-Effective Amendment No. 1 
to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 333-49645) of Amkor 
Technology of our report dated March 20, 1998 on our audits of the financial 
statements of Amam Industrial Co., Ltd. and its subsidiaries. We also consent 
to the references to our firm under the caption "Experts."


                                          Samil Accounting Corporation


Seoul, Korea
May 14, 1998

   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.5
 
 
   
As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of our report
and to all references to our firm included in or made a part of Post-Effective 
Amendment No. 1 to the Amkor Technology, Inc. Registration Statement 
(No. 333-49645) on Form S-1.
    
 
                                        /s/ SYCIP GORRES VELAYO & CO.
                                        --------------------------------------
 
Makali City, Philippines
May 20, 1998

 

5 1,000 YEAR DEC-31-1998 JAN-01-1998 MAR-31-1998 41,989 2,952 108,803 5,413 103,390 299,223 656,939 374,849 786,888 374,849 0 0 0 46 100,304 786,888 371,733 371,733 310,056 340,828 16,358 0 9,522 14,547 5,050 9,497 0 0 0 8,812 .12 .12